1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
27 #include "blockinput.h"
28 #include "syssignal.h"
30 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
31 if this is not done before the other system files. */
33 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
35 /* If we have Xfixes extension, use it for pointer blanking. */
37 #include <X11/extensions/Xfixes.h>
40 /* Using Xft implies that XRender is available. */
42 #include <X11/extensions/Xrender.h>
45 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
46 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
48 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
58 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
59 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
62 #include "character.h"
65 #include "dispextern.h"
67 #include "termhooks.h"
70 #include "emacs-icon.h"
75 #include "intervals.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
86 #include <X11/Shell.h>
94 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
98 #if defined (USE_LUCID) || defined (USE_MOTIF)
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
103 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget
, XtPointer
, XEvent
*, Boolean
*);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* For LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
139 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
142 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
145 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
149 bool use_xim
= false; /* configure --without-xim */
152 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
155 static bool any_help_event_p
;
157 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
160 struct x_display_info
*x_display_list
;
164 /* The application context for Xt use. */
165 XtAppContext Xt_app_con
;
166 static String Xt_default_resources
[] = {0};
168 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
169 static bool toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
;
171 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
173 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
174 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
175 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
177 static Time ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
;
179 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
181 static int x_noop_count
;
183 static Lisp_Object Qalt
, Qhyper
, Qmeta
, Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
;
185 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms
;
186 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1
;
189 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
190 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file
;
192 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
193 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock
;
196 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
197 static char emacs_class
[] = EMACS_CLASS
;
201 XEMBED_MAPPED
= 1 << 0
206 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY
= 0,
207 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE
= 1,
208 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE
= 2,
209 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
= 3,
211 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
= 5,
212 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT
= 6,
213 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV
= 7,
215 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON
= 10,
216 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF
= 11,
217 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 12,
218 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 13,
219 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR
= 14
222 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*, Colormap
, XColor
*);
223 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*, int, int, int, bool);
224 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame
*);
225 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame
*);
226 static const XColor
*x_color_cells (Display
*, int *);
227 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display
*);
228 static struct terminal
*x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*);
229 static void x_update_end (struct frame
*);
230 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*);
231 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame
*);
232 static _Noreturn
void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*, int, int);
233 static void frame_highlight (struct frame
*);
234 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*);
235 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*, struct frame
*);
236 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info
*,
237 struct frame
*, struct input_event
*);
238 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*);
239 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*);
240 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*);
241 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int,
242 enum text_cursor_kinds
);
244 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*,
245 enum glyph_row_area
, GC
);
246 static void x_flush (struct frame
*f
);
247 static void x_update_begin (struct frame
*);
248 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window
*);
249 static struct scroll_bar
*x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*, Window
, int);
250 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**, Lisp_Object
*,
251 enum scroll_bar_part
*,
252 Lisp_Object
*, Lisp_Object
*,
254 static void x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**, Lisp_Object
*,
255 enum scroll_bar_part
*,
256 Lisp_Object
*, Lisp_Object
*,
258 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*, const XPropertyEvent
*);
259 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*);
260 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*, int, int);
261 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*, int, int, int);
262 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*,
263 const XEvent
*, int *,
264 struct input_event
*);
265 #if ! (defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_MOTIF)
266 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*, Display
*);
268 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
269 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
270 static void x_connection_closed (Display
*, const char *);
271 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*, int);
272 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*, ptrdiff_t);
273 static void x_initialize (void);
275 static int get_current_wm_state (struct frame
*, Window
, int *, int *);
277 /* Flush display of frame F. */
280 x_flush (struct frame
*f
)
282 eassert (f
&& FRAME_X_P (f
));
283 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
284 connection may be broken. */
285 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay
))
289 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
294 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
295 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
296 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
297 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
298 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
301 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
304 /***********************************************************************
306 ***********************************************************************/
310 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
311 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
319 struct record event_record
[100];
321 int event_record_index
;
324 record_event (char *locus
, int type
)
326 if (event_record_index
== ARRAYELTS (event_record
))
327 event_record_index
= 0;
329 event_record
[event_record_index
].locus
= locus
;
330 event_record
[event_record_index
].type
= type
;
331 event_record_index
++;
338 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
340 struct x_display_info
*
341 x_display_info_for_display (Display
*dpy
)
343 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
345 for (dpyinfo
= x_display_list
; dpyinfo
; dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
)
346 if (dpyinfo
->display
== dpy
)
353 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame
*f
)
355 struct x_output
*x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
356 Window win
= None
, wi
= x
->parent_desc
;
357 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
359 while (wi
!= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
363 unsigned int nchildren
;
366 if (XQueryTree (dpy
, win
, &root
, &wi
, &children
, &nchildren
))
375 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
378 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame
*f
)
380 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
381 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
382 Window win
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
384 double alpha_min
= 1.0;
388 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
393 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
394 alpha_min
= XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
);
395 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
396 alpha_min
= (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
)) / 100.0;
400 else if (alpha
> 1.0)
402 else if (0.0 <= alpha
&& alpha
< alpha_min
&& alpha_min
<= 1.0)
405 opac
= alpha
* OPAQUE
;
407 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
409 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
410 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
411 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
412 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
414 parent
= x_find_topmost_parent (f
);
416 XChangeProperty (dpy
, parent
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
417 XA_CARDINAL
, 32, PropModeReplace
,
418 (unsigned char *) &opac
, 1);
420 /* return unless necessary */
425 unsigned long n
, left
;
427 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
428 0, 1, False
, XA_CARDINAL
,
429 &actual
, &format
, &n
, &left
,
432 if (rc
== Success
&& actual
!= None
)
434 unsigned long value
= *(unsigned long *)data
;
444 XChangeProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
445 XA_CARDINAL
, 32, PropModeReplace
,
446 (unsigned char *) &opac
, 1);
450 /***********************************************************************
451 Starting and ending an update
452 ***********************************************************************/
454 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
455 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
456 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
457 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
458 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
461 x_update_begin (struct frame
*f
)
467 /* Start update of window W. */
470 x_update_window_begin (struct window
*w
)
472 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
473 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
);
475 w
->output_cursor
= w
->cursor
;
479 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
481 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
482 hlinfo
->mouse_face_defer
= 1;
484 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
486 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f
))
487 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
494 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
497 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window
*w
, int x
, int y0
, int y1
)
499 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
502 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID
);
504 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
507 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
508 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, x
, y0
, x
, y1
);
511 /* Draw a window divider from (x0,y0) to (x1,y1) */
514 x_draw_window_divider (struct window
*w
, int x0
, int x1
, int y0
, int y1
)
516 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
517 struct face
*face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FACE_ID
);
518 struct face
*face_first
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FIRST_PIXEL_FACE_ID
);
519 struct face
*face_last
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, WINDOW_DIVIDER_LAST_PIXEL_FACE_ID
);
520 unsigned long color
= face
? face
->foreground
: FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
);
521 unsigned long color_first
= (face_first
522 ? face_first
->foreground
523 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
524 unsigned long color_last
= (face_last
525 ? face_last
->foreground
526 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
527 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
528 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
530 if (y1
- y0
> x1
- x0
&& x1
- x0
> 2)
533 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color_first
);
534 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
536 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color
);
537 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
538 x0
+ 1, y0
, x1
- x0
- 2, y1
- y0
);
539 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color_last
);
540 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
541 x1
- 1, y0
, 1, y1
- y0
);
543 else if (x1
- x0
> y1
- y0
&& y1
- y0
> 3)
546 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color_first
);
547 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
549 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color
);
550 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
551 x0
, y0
+ 1, x1
- x0
, y1
- y0
- 2);
552 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color_last
);
553 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
554 x0
, y1
- 1, x1
- x0
, 1);
558 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color
);
559 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
560 x0
, y0
, x1
- x0
, y1
- y0
);
564 /* End update of window W.
566 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
567 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
569 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
570 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
571 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
573 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
574 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
578 x_update_window_end (struct window
*w
, bool cursor_on_p
,
579 bool mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
581 if (!w
->pseudo_window_p
)
586 display_and_set_cursor (w
, 1,
587 w
->output_cursor
.hpos
, w
->output_cursor
.vpos
,
588 w
->output_cursor
.x
, w
->output_cursor
.y
);
590 if (draw_window_fringes (w
, 1))
592 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w
))
593 x_draw_right_divider (w
);
595 x_draw_vertical_border (w
);
601 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
602 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
603 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
605 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w
->frame
));
607 hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
608 hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
609 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
614 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
618 x_update_end (struct frame
*f
)
620 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
621 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
)->mouse_face_defer
= 0;
625 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
631 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c
632 whenever a complete update has been performed. */
635 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*f
)
638 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f
);
642 /* Clear under internal border if any (GTK has its own version). */
645 x_clear_under_internal_border (struct frame
*f
)
647 if (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
) > 0)
649 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
650 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
651 int border
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
652 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
653 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
654 int margin
= FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
);
657 x_clear_area (display
, window
, 0, 0, border
, height
);
658 x_clear_area (display
, window
, 0, margin
, width
, border
);
659 x_clear_area (display
, window
, width
- border
, 0, border
, height
);
660 x_clear_area (display
, window
, 0, height
- border
, width
, border
);
666 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
667 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
668 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. This function is called from
669 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
670 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
673 x_after_update_window_line (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*desired_row
)
677 if (!desired_row
->mode_line_p
&& !w
->pseudo_window_p
)
678 desired_row
->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p
= 1;
681 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
682 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
683 check here if updated window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
684 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
685 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
686 overhead is very small. */
691 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
692 && desired_row
->full_width_p
693 && (f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
),
694 width
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
696 && (height
= desired_row
->visible_height
,
699 int y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, desired_row
->y
));
702 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
703 0, y
, width
, height
);
704 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
705 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - width
,
714 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params
*p
)
716 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
717 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
718 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
719 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
720 struct face
*face
= p
->face
;
722 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
723 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, ANY_AREA
, gc
);
725 if (p
->bx
>= 0 && !p
->overlay_p
)
727 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
728 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
729 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
730 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
732 XSetFillStyle (display
, face
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
734 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->background
);
736 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, face
->gc
,
737 p
->bx
, p
->by
, p
->nx
, p
->ny
);
740 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->foreground
);
746 Pixmap pixmap
, clipmask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
747 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
));
751 bits
= (char *) (p
->bits
+ p
->dh
);
753 bits
= (char *) p
->bits
+ p
->dh
;
755 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
757 pixmap
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
, window
, bits
, p
->wd
, p
->h
,
759 ? (p
->overlay_p
? face
->background
760 : f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
762 face
->background
, depth
);
766 clipmask
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
,
767 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
,
770 gcv
.clip_mask
= clipmask
;
771 gcv
.clip_x_origin
= p
->x
;
772 gcv
.clip_y_origin
= p
->y
;
773 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
, &gcv
);
776 XCopyArea (display
, pixmap
, window
, gc
, 0, 0,
777 p
->wd
, p
->h
, p
->x
, p
->y
);
778 XFreePixmap (display
, pixmap
);
782 gcv
.clip_mask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
783 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
, &gcv
);
784 XFreePixmap (display
, clipmask
);
788 XSetClipMask (display
, gc
, None
);
791 /***********************************************************************
793 ***********************************************************************/
797 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*);
798 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
799 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
800 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
801 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*);
802 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
803 static _Noreturn
void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*, int);
804 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*);
805 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
806 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
807 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
808 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*, Display
*, Colormap
,
809 unsigned long *, double, int);
810 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*, struct relief
*,
811 double, int, unsigned long);
812 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*);
813 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
814 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*);
815 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
816 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*, Pixmap
);
817 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int,
819 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*, int, int, int, int,
820 int, int, int, int, int, int,
822 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int, int, int, int,
823 int, int, int, XRectangle
*);
824 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame
*);
827 static void x_check_font (struct frame
*, struct font
*);
831 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
835 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
837 if (s
->font
== FRAME_FONT (s
->f
)
838 && s
->face
->background
== FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
839 && s
->face
->foreground
== FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
841 s
->gc
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_gc
;
844 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
848 xgcv
.background
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
849 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
851 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
852 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
853 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
854 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
855 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
;
856 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
857 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
859 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
860 if (xgcv
.background
== s
->face
->background
861 && xgcv
.foreground
== s
->face
->foreground
)
863 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->foreground
;
864 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
867 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s
->f
, s
->font
));
868 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
869 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
871 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
872 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
875 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
876 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
878 s
->gc
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
883 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
886 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
891 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
892 face_id
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (s
->f
)->mouse_face_face_id
;
893 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
895 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, MOUSE_FACE_ID
);
897 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
898 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, s
->first_glyph
->u
.ch
, -1, Qnil
);
900 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, 0, -1, Qnil
);
901 s
->face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
902 prepare_face_for_display (s
->f
, s
->face
);
904 if (s
->font
== s
->face
->font
)
908 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
913 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->background
;
914 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
915 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
916 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
918 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
919 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
922 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
923 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
925 s
->gc
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
928 eassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
932 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
933 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
934 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
937 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
943 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
944 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
948 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
950 prepare_face_for_display (s
->f
, s
->face
);
952 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
)
955 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
957 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO
)
959 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s
);
960 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
962 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
967 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
)
969 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
970 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
972 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
973 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
976 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
981 /* GC must have been set. */
982 eassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
986 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
987 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
990 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*s
)
992 XRectangle
*r
= s
->clip
;
993 int n
= get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s
, r
, 2);
996 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, r
, n
, Unsorted
);
1001 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1002 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1006 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string
*src
, struct glyph_string
*dst
)
1011 r
.width
= src
->width
;
1013 r
.height
= src
->height
;
1016 XSetClipRectangles (dst
->display
, dst
->gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
1021 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1024 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1027 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
1028 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
1030 struct font_metrics metrics
;
1032 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
1034 unsigned *code
= alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s
->nchars
);
1035 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1038 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++)
1039 code
[i
] = (s
->char2b
[i
].byte1
<< 8) | s
->char2b
[i
].byte2
;
1040 font
->driver
->text_extents (font
, code
, s
->nchars
, &metrics
);
1044 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1046 composition_gstring_width (gstring
, s
->cmp_from
, s
->cmp_to
, &metrics
);
1048 s
->right_overhang
= (metrics
.rbearing
> metrics
.width
1049 ? metrics
.rbearing
- metrics
.width
: 0);
1050 s
->left_overhang
= metrics
.lbearing
< 0 ? - metrics
.lbearing
: 0;
1054 s
->right_overhang
= s
->cmp
->rbearing
- s
->cmp
->pixel_width
;
1055 s
->left_overhang
= - s
->cmp
->lbearing
;
1060 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1063 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
1066 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1067 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
1068 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
1069 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
1073 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1074 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1075 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1076 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1077 contains the first component of a composition. */
1080 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string
*s
, bool force_p
)
1082 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1083 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1084 if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
1086 int box_line_width
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
1090 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1091 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
1092 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
,
1093 s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1094 s
->background_width
,
1095 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1096 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
1097 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1099 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s
->font
) < s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
1100 || s
->font_not_found_p
1101 || s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1104 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1105 s
->background_width
,
1106 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1107 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1113 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1116 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1120 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1121 of S to the right of that box line. */
1122 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1123 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1124 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1128 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1130 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1132 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; ++i
)
1134 struct glyph
*g
= s
->first_glyph
+ i
;
1135 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
,
1136 s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
, g
->pixel_width
- 1,
1138 x
+= g
->pixel_width
;
1143 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1144 int boff
= font
->baseline_offset
;
1147 if (font
->vertical_centering
)
1148 boff
= VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font
, s
->f
) - boff
;
1150 y
= s
->ybase
- boff
;
1152 || (s
->background_filled_p
&& s
->hl
!= DRAW_CURSOR
))
1153 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, 0);
1155 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, 1);
1156 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1157 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1161 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1164 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1167 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1169 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1170 of S to the right of that box line. */
1171 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1172 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1173 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1177 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1178 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1179 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1180 this composition. */
1182 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1183 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1184 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1186 if (s
->cmp_from
== 0)
1187 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
,
1188 s
->width
- 1, s
->height
- 1);
1190 else if (! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
)
1194 for (i
= 0, j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, j
++)
1195 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1196 space on the left or right. */
1197 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s
->cmp
, j
) != '\t')
1199 int xx
= x
+ s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2];
1200 int yy
= y
- s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2 + 1];
1202 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
, yy
, 0);
1203 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1204 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
+ 1, yy
, 0);
1209 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1214 for (i
= j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->cmp_to
; i
++)
1216 glyph
= LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring
, i
);
1217 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph
)))
1218 width
+= LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph
);
1221 int xoff
, yoff
, wadjust
;
1225 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, 0);
1226 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1227 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1230 xoff
= LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph
);
1231 yoff
= LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph
);
1232 wadjust
= LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph
);
1233 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
, y
+ yoff
, 0);
1234 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1235 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
+ 1, y
+ yoff
, 0);
1243 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, 0);
1244 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1245 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1251 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1254 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1256 struct glyph
*glyph
= s
->first_glyph
;
1260 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1261 of S to the right of that box line. */
1262 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1263 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1264 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1270 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, glyph
++)
1272 char buf
[7], *str
= NULL
;
1273 int len
= glyph
->u
.glyphless
.len
;
1275 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM
)
1278 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display
)
1279 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
))
1283 = (! glyph
->u
.glyphless
.for_no_font
1284 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display
,
1285 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
)
1286 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
)->extras
[0]);
1287 if (STRINGP (acronym
))
1288 str
= SSDATA (acronym
);
1291 else if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE
)
1293 sprintf (buf
, "%0*X",
1294 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
< 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1295 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
);
1301 int upper_len
= (len
+ 1) / 2;
1304 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1305 for (j
= 0; j
< len
; j
++)
1307 code
= s
->font
->driver
->encode_char (s
->font
, str
[j
]);
1308 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b
+ j
, code
>> 8, code
& 0xFF);
1310 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, upper_len
,
1311 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_xoff
,
1312 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_yoff
,
1314 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, upper_len
, len
,
1315 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_xoff
,
1316 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_yoff
,
1319 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
!= GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE
)
1320 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
1321 x
, s
->ybase
- glyph
->ascent
,
1322 glyph
->pixel_width
- 1,
1323 glyph
->ascent
+ glyph
->descent
- 1);
1324 x
+= glyph
->pixel_width
;
1328 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1332 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1333 cannot be determined. */
1335 static struct frame
*
1336 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget
)
1338 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
1339 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
1342 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget
));
1344 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1345 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1346 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1347 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1348 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget
))
1349 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
1351 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1352 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1353 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
1357 && f
->output_data
.nothing
!= 1
1358 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
1359 && f
->output_data
.x
->widget
== widget
)
1365 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1366 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1367 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1368 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1369 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1370 Value is true if successful. */
1373 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
,
1374 unsigned long *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1376 struct frame
*f
= x_frame_of_widget (widget
);
1377 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, display
, cmap
, pixel
, factor
, delta
);
1380 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1383 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1384 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1386 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args
[] =
1388 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.screen
),
1390 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.colormap
),
1395 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1396 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1398 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1401 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1403 DPY is the display we are working on.
1405 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1406 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1407 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1408 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1410 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1411 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1413 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1414 we allocated the color or not.
1416 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1419 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display
*dpy
, XrmValue
*args
, Cardinal
*nargs
,
1420 XrmValue
*from
, XrmValue
*to
,
1421 XtPointer
*closure_ret
)
1431 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1432 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1434 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL
, NULL
);
1438 screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1439 cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1440 color_name
= (String
) from
->addr
;
1442 if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultBackground
) == 0)
1444 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1445 pixel
= WhitePixelOfScreen (screen
);
1447 else if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultForeground
) == 0)
1449 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1450 pixel
= BlackPixelOfScreen (screen
);
1452 else if (XParseColor (dpy
, cmap
, color_name
, &color
)
1453 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy
, cmap
, &color
))
1455 pixel
= color
.pixel
;
1456 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) True
;
1461 Cardinal nparams
= 1;
1463 params
[0] = color_name
;
1464 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1465 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1466 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1471 if (to
->addr
!= NULL
)
1473 if (to
->size
< sizeof (Pixel
))
1475 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1479 *(Pixel
*) to
->addr
= pixel
;
1483 cvt_string_to_pixel_value
= pixel
;
1484 to
->addr
= (XtPointer
) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1487 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1492 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1493 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1494 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1496 APP is the application context in which we work.
1498 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1499 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1500 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1502 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1505 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app
, XrmValuePtr to
, XtPointer closure
, XrmValuePtr args
,
1510 XtAppWarningMsg (app
, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1512 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1515 else if (closure
!= NULL
)
1517 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1518 Screen
*screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1519 Colormap cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1520 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen
), screen
, cmap
,
1521 (Pixel
*) to
->addr
, 1);
1526 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1529 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1530 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1531 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1532 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1534 static const XColor
*
1535 x_color_cells (Display
*dpy
, int *ncells
)
1537 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1539 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
== NULL
)
1541 Screen
*screen
= dpyinfo
->screen
;
1542 int ncolor_cells
= XDisplayCells (dpy
, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen
));
1545 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= xnmalloc (ncolor_cells
,
1546 sizeof *dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1547 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= ncolor_cells
;
1549 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolor_cells
; ++i
)
1550 dpyinfo
->color_cells
[i
].pixel
= i
;
1552 XQueryColors (dpy
, dpyinfo
->cmap
,
1553 dpyinfo
->color_cells
, ncolor_cells
);
1556 *ncells
= dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
;
1557 return dpyinfo
->color_cells
;
1561 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1562 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1565 x_query_colors (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*colors
, int ncolors
)
1567 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1569 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
)
1572 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolors
; ++i
)
1574 unsigned long pixel
= colors
[i
].pixel
;
1575 eassert (pixel
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1576 eassert (dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
].pixel
== pixel
);
1577 colors
[i
] = dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
];
1581 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), colors
, ncolors
);
1585 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1586 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1589 x_query_color (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*color
)
1591 x_query_colors (f
, color
, 1);
1595 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1596 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1597 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1601 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*dpy
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1605 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
) != 0;
1608 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1609 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1610 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1611 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1613 int max_color_delta
= 255;
1614 int max_delta
= 3 * max_color_delta
;
1615 int nearest_delta
= max_delta
+ 1;
1617 const XColor
*cells
= x_color_cells (dpy
, &ncells
);
1619 for (nearest
= i
= 0; i
< ncells
; ++i
)
1621 int dred
= (color
->red
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].red
>> 8);
1622 int dgreen
= (color
->green
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].green
>> 8);
1623 int dblue
= (color
->blue
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].blue
>> 8);
1624 int delta
= dred
* dred
+ dgreen
* dgreen
+ dblue
* dblue
;
1626 if (delta
< nearest_delta
)
1629 nearest_delta
= delta
;
1633 color
->red
= cells
[nearest
].red
;
1634 color
->green
= cells
[nearest
].green
;
1635 color
->blue
= cells
[nearest
].blue
;
1636 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
) != 0;
1640 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1641 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1642 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1643 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1644 XColor
*cached_color
;
1646 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
1647 && (cached_color
= &dpyinfo
->color_cells
[color
->pixel
],
1648 (cached_color
->red
!= color
->red
1649 || cached_color
->blue
!= color
->blue
1650 || cached_color
->green
!= color
->green
)))
1652 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1653 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= NULL
;
1654 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= 0;
1658 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1660 register_color (color
->pixel
);
1661 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1667 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1668 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1669 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1673 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame
*f
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1675 gamma_correct (f
, color
);
1676 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), cmap
, color
);
1680 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1681 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1682 get color reference counts right. */
1685 x_copy_color (struct frame
*f
, unsigned long pixel
)
1689 color
.pixel
= pixel
;
1691 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1692 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), &color
);
1694 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1695 register_color (pixel
);
1701 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1704 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1705 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1706 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1707 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1708 use an additional additive factor.
1710 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1711 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1712 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1715 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1716 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1717 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1718 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1719 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1720 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1723 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*f
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
,
1724 unsigned long *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1730 /* Get RGB color values. */
1731 color
.pixel
= *pixel
;
1732 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1734 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1735 eassert (factor
>= 0);
1736 new.red
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.red
);
1737 new.green
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.green
);
1738 new.blue
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.blue
);
1740 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1741 bright
= (2 * color
.red
+ 3 * color
.green
+ color
.blue
) / 6;
1743 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1744 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1745 if (bright
< HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
)
1746 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1747 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1749 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1750 double dimness
= 1 - (double)bright
/ HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
;
1751 /* The additive adjustment. */
1752 int min_delta
= delta
* dimness
* factor
/ 2;
1756 new.red
= max (0, new.red
- min_delta
);
1757 new.green
= max (0, new.green
- min_delta
);
1758 new.blue
= max (0, new.blue
- min_delta
);
1762 new.red
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.red
);
1763 new.green
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.green
);
1764 new.blue
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.blue
);
1768 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1769 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1772 if (new.pixel
== *pixel
)
1774 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1775 delta to the RGB values. */
1776 x_free_colors (f
, &new.pixel
, 1);
1778 new.red
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.red
);
1779 new.green
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.green
);
1780 new.blue
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.blue
);
1781 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1792 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1793 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1794 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1795 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1796 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1797 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1800 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*f
, struct relief
*relief
, double factor
,
1801 int delta
, unsigned long default_pixel
)
1804 struct x_output
*di
= f
->output_data
.x
;
1805 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCLineWidth
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
1806 unsigned long pixel
;
1807 unsigned long background
= di
->relief_background
;
1808 Colormap cmap
= FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
);
1809 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1810 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1812 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
1813 xgcv
.line_width
= 1;
1815 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1816 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1817 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1818 if (relief
->gc
&& relief
->pixel
!= -1)
1820 x_free_colors (f
, &relief
->pixel
, 1);
1824 /* Allocate new color. */
1825 xgcv
.foreground
= default_pixel
;
1827 if (dpyinfo
->n_planes
!= 1
1828 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, dpy
, cmap
, &pixel
, factor
, delta
))
1829 xgcv
.foreground
= relief
->pixel
= pixel
;
1831 if (relief
->gc
== 0)
1833 xgcv
.stipple
= dpyinfo
->gray
;
1835 relief
->gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), mask
, &xgcv
);
1838 XChangeGC (dpy
, relief
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1842 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1845 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1847 struct x_output
*di
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
;
1848 unsigned long color
;
1850 if (s
->face
->use_box_color_for_shadows_p
)
1851 color
= s
->face
->box_color
;
1852 else if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
1854 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0))
1855 color
= IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0);
1860 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1861 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1862 color
= xgcv
.background
;
1865 if (di
->white_relief
.gc
== 0
1866 || color
!= di
->relief_background
)
1868 di
->relief_background
= color
;
1869 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->white_relief
, 1.2, 0x8000,
1870 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1871 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->black_relief
, 0.6, 0x4000,
1872 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1877 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1878 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1879 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1880 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1881 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1882 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1886 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*f
,
1887 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
1888 int raised_p
, int top_p
, int bot_p
, int left_p
, int right_p
,
1889 XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
1891 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1892 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
1897 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
1899 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
1900 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
1902 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1903 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1904 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1911 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1912 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), top_y
,
1913 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), top_y
);
1915 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
1916 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1917 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, top_y
+ i
,
1918 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, top_y
+ i
);
1925 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
1927 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1928 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1930 for (i
= (width
> 1 ? 1 : 0); i
< width
; ++i
)
1931 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1932 left_x
+ i
, top_y
+ (i
+ 1) * top_p
,
1933 left_x
+ i
, bottom_y
+ 1 - (i
+ 1) * bot_p
);
1936 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
1938 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
1940 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
1941 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
1945 /* Outermost top line. */
1947 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1948 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), top_y
,
1949 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), top_y
);
1951 /* Outermost left line. */
1953 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
1959 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1960 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), bottom_y
,
1961 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), bottom_y
);
1962 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
1963 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1964 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, bottom_y
- i
,
1965 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, bottom_y
- i
);
1971 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1972 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1973 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
1974 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1975 right_x
- i
, top_y
+ (i
+ 1) * top_p
,
1976 right_x
- i
, bottom_y
+ 1 - (i
+ 1) * bot_p
);
1979 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
1983 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
1984 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
1985 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
1986 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
1987 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
1988 rectangle to use when drawing. */
1991 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
,
1992 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
1993 int left_p
, int right_p
, XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
1997 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
1998 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->box_color
);
1999 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2002 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2003 left_x
, top_y
, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2007 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2008 left_x
, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2011 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2012 left_x
, bottom_y
- width
+ 1, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2016 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2017 right_x
- width
+ 1, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2019 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2020 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2024 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2027 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2029 int width
, left_x
, right_x
, top_y
, bottom_y
, last_x
, raised_p
;
2030 int left_p
, right_p
;
2031 struct glyph
*last_glyph
;
2032 XRectangle clip_rect
;
2034 last_x
= ((s
->row
->full_width_p
&& !s
->w
->pseudo_window_p
)
2035 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s
->w
)
2036 : window_box_right (s
->w
, s
->area
));
2038 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2039 last_glyph
= (s
->cmp
|| s
->img
2041 : s
->first_glyph
+ s
->nchars
- 1);
2043 width
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2044 raised_p
= s
->face
->box
== FACE_RAISED_BOX
;
2046 right_x
= (s
->row
->full_width_p
&& s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2048 : min (last_x
, s
->x
+ s
->background_width
) - 1);
2050 bottom_y
= top_y
+ s
->height
- 1;
2052 left_p
= (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2053 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2055 || s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2056 right_p
= (last_glyph
->right_box_line_p
2057 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2059 || s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2061 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2063 if (s
->face
->box
== FACE_SIMPLE_BOX
)
2064 x_draw_box_rect (s
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
,
2065 left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2068 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2069 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
,
2070 width
, raised_p
, 1, 1, left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2075 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2078 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2081 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2083 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2084 right of that line. */
2085 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2086 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2088 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2090 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2092 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2093 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2094 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2095 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2101 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2102 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2103 trust on the shape extension to be available
2104 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2106 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2109 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2111 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2112 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
;
2113 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
;
2114 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2115 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2117 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2120 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2121 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2122 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2123 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2124 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2125 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2129 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2131 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2134 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2135 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2136 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2137 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2138 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2139 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2141 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2142 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2143 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2144 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2145 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2146 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2147 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2149 int relief
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2150 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2151 x
- relief
, y
- relief
,
2152 s
->slice
.width
+ relief
*2 - 1,
2153 s
->slice
.height
+ relief
*2 - 1);
2158 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2159 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2160 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2164 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2167 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2169 int x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
, top_p
, bot_p
, left_p
, right_p
;
2170 int extra_x
, extra_y
;
2173 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2175 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2176 right of that line. */
2177 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2178 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2180 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2182 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2184 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2185 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2186 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2187 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2189 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2190 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
)
2192 thick
= tool_bar_button_relief
>= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief
: DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF
;
2193 raised_p
= s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
;
2197 thick
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2198 raised_p
= s
->img
->relief
> 0;
2201 x1
= x
+ s
->slice
.width
- 1;
2202 y1
= y
+ s
->slice
.height
- 1;
2204 extra_x
= extra_y
= 0;
2205 if (s
->face
->id
== TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
)
2207 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin
)
2208 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin
))
2209 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin
)))
2211 extra_x
= XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin
));
2212 extra_y
= XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin
));
2214 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin
))
2215 extra_x
= extra_y
= XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin
);
2218 top_p
= bot_p
= left_p
= right_p
= 0;
2220 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2221 x
-= thick
+ extra_x
, left_p
= 1;
2222 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2223 y
-= thick
+ extra_y
, top_p
= 1;
2224 if (s
->slice
.x
+ s
->slice
.width
== s
->img
->width
)
2225 x1
+= thick
+ extra_x
, right_p
= 1;
2226 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
== s
->img
->height
)
2227 y1
+= thick
+ extra_y
, bot_p
= 1;
2229 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2230 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2231 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, x
, y
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
,
2232 top_p
, bot_p
, left_p
, right_p
, &r
);
2236 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2239 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*s
, Pixmap pixmap
)
2242 int y
= s
->ybase
- s
->y
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2244 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2245 right of that line. */
2246 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2247 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2249 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2251 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2253 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2254 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2255 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2256 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2262 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2263 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2264 trust on the shape extension to be available
2265 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2267 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2271 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2272 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
- s
->slice
.x
;
2273 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
- s
->slice
.y
;
2274 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2275 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2277 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2278 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2279 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2280 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2284 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2285 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2286 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2288 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2289 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2290 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2291 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2292 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2293 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2294 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2296 int r
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2297 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
- r
, y
- r
,
2298 s
->slice
.width
+ r
*2 - 1,
2299 s
->slice
.height
+ r
*2 - 1);
2304 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2305 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2306 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2310 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2311 give the rectangle to draw. */
2314 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
2318 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2319 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2320 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2321 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2324 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2328 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2331 s->x +-------------------------
2334 | +-------------------------
2337 | | +-------------------
2343 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2345 int box_line_hwidth
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2346 int box_line_vwidth
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
2348 Pixmap pixmap
= None
;
2351 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2352 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2353 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
>= s
->img
->height
)
2354 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2356 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2357 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2359 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
2360 if (height
> s
->slice
.height
2364 || s
->img
->pixmap
== 0
2365 || s
->width
!= s
->background_width
)
2369 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2370 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2371 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2372 Screen
*screen
= FRAME_X_SCREEN (s
->f
);
2373 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen
);
2375 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2376 pixmap
= XCreatePixmap (s
->display
, s
->window
,
2377 s
->background_width
,
2380 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2382 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2384 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2387 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2388 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2389 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, - s
->x
, - s
->y
);
2390 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2391 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2392 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2393 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0);
2398 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
,
2400 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2401 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2402 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2403 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2410 int width
= s
->background_width
;
2412 if (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2415 x
+= box_line_hwidth
;
2416 width
-= box_line_hwidth
;
2419 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2420 y
+= box_line_vwidth
;
2422 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, y
, width
, height
);
2425 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2428 /* Draw the foreground. */
2431 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s
, pixmap
);
2432 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2433 XCopyArea (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2434 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
, s
->x
, s
->y
);
2435 XFreePixmap (s
->display
, pixmap
);
2438 x_draw_image_foreground (s
);
2440 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2442 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2443 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
2444 x_draw_image_relief (s
);
2448 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2451 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2453 eassert (s
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
);
2455 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
2456 && !x_stretch_cursor_p
)
2458 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2459 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2460 int width
, background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2463 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2465 int left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2469 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2475 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2477 int right_x
= window_box_right (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2479 if (x
+ background_width
> right_x
)
2480 background_width
-= x
- right_x
;
2481 x
+= background_width
;
2483 width
= min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s
->f
), background_width
);
2484 if (s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2488 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, width
, s
->height
);
2490 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2491 if (width
< background_width
)
2494 int w
= background_width
- width
, h
= s
->height
;
2498 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2502 if (s
->row
->mouse_face_p
2503 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s
->w
))
2505 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
2511 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2512 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
2514 if (s
->face
->stipple
)
2516 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2517 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2518 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2519 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillSolid
);
2524 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
2525 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2526 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2527 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2530 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, gc
, None
);
2533 else if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
2535 int background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2536 int x
= s
->x
, left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2538 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2539 except for header line and mode line. */
2540 if (x
< left_x
&& !s
->row
->mode_line_p
)
2542 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2545 if (background_width
> 0)
2546 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, background_width
, s
->height
);
2549 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2553 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2559 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2564 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2566 int wave_height
= 3, wave_length
= 2;
2567 int dx
, dy
, x0
, y0
, width
, x1
, y1
, x2
, y2
, odd
, xmax
;
2568 XRectangle wave_clip
, string_clip
, final_clip
;
2571 dy
= wave_height
- 1;
2573 y0
= s
->ybase
- wave_height
+ 3;
2577 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2581 wave_clip
.width
= width
;
2582 wave_clip
.height
= wave_height
;
2583 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &string_clip
);
2585 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip
, &string_clip
, &final_clip
))
2588 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, &final_clip
, 1, Unsorted
);
2590 /* Draw the waves */
2592 x1
= x0
- (x0
% dx
);
2602 if (INT_MAX
- dx
< xmax
)
2607 XDrawLine (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x1
, y1
, x2
, y2
);
2609 x2
+= dx
, y2
= y0
+ odd
*dy
;
2613 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2614 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, s
->clip
, s
->num_clips
, Unsorted
);
2618 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2621 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2623 bool relief_drawn_p
= 0;
2625 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2626 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2627 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2628 if (s
->next
&& s
->right_overhang
&& !s
->for_overlaps
)
2631 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2633 for (width
= 0, next
= s
->next
;
2634 next
&& width
< s
->right_overhang
;
2635 width
+= next
->width
, next
= next
->next
)
2636 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
!= IMAGE_GLYPH
)
2638 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2639 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next
);
2640 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
)
2641 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next
);
2643 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next
, 1);
2644 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2648 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2649 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s
);
2651 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2652 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2653 if (!s
->for_overlaps
2654 && s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2655 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
2656 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
2659 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2660 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2661 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2662 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2665 else if (!s
->clip_head
/* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2667 && ((s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->left_overhang
)
2668 || (s
->next
&& s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->right_overhang
)))
2669 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2670 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2671 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2672 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, s
);
2674 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2676 switch (s
->first_glyph
->type
)
2679 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s
);
2683 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s
);
2687 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2688 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2690 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 0);
2691 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2694 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH
:
2695 if (s
->for_overlaps
|| (s
->cmp_from
> 0
2696 && ! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
))
2697 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2699 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2700 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2703 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
:
2704 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2705 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2707 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2708 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2715 if (!s
->for_overlaps
)
2717 /* Draw underline. */
2718 if (s
->face
->underline_p
)
2720 if (s
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_WAVE
)
2722 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2723 x_draw_underwave (s
);
2727 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2728 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2729 x_draw_underwave (s
);
2730 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2733 else if (s
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_LINE
)
2735 unsigned long thickness
, position
;
2738 if (s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->face
->underline_p
2739 && s
->prev
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_LINE
)
2741 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2742 thickness
= s
->prev
->underline_thickness
;
2743 position
= s
->prev
->underline_position
;
2747 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2748 if (s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_thickness
> 0)
2749 thickness
= s
->font
->underline_thickness
;
2752 if (x_underline_at_descent_line
)
2753 position
= (s
->height
- thickness
) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2756 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2757 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2758 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2759 specs, and its default is
2761 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2762 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2764 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2765 && s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_position
>= 0)
2766 position
= s
->font
->underline_position
;
2768 position
= (s
->font
->descent
+ 1) / 2;
2770 position
= underline_minimum_offset
;
2772 position
= max (position
, underline_minimum_offset
);
2774 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2775 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2776 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
<= s
->ybase
+ position
)
2777 position
= (s
->height
- 1) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2778 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
< s
->ybase
+ position
+ thickness
)
2779 thickness
= (s
->y
+ s
->height
) - (s
->ybase
+ position
);
2780 s
->underline_thickness
= thickness
;
2781 s
->underline_position
= position
;
2782 y
= s
->ybase
+ position
;
2783 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2784 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2785 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2789 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2790 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2791 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2792 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2793 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2797 /* Draw overline. */
2798 if (s
->face
->overline_p
)
2800 unsigned long dy
= 0, h
= 1;
2802 if (s
->face
->overline_color_defaulted_p
)
2803 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2808 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2809 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->overline_color
);
2810 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2812 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2816 /* Draw strike-through. */
2817 if (s
->face
->strike_through_p
)
2819 unsigned long h
= 1;
2820 unsigned long dy
= (s
->height
- h
) / 2;
2822 if (s
->face
->strike_through_color_defaulted_p
)
2823 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2828 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2829 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->strike_through_color
);
2830 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2832 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2836 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2837 if (!relief_drawn_p
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
)
2838 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2842 struct glyph_string
*prev
;
2844 for (prev
= s
->prev
; prev
; prev
= prev
->prev
)
2845 if (prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
2846 && prev
->x
+ prev
->width
+ prev
->right_overhang
> s
->x
)
2848 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2849 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2850 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= prev
->hl
;
2853 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev
);
2854 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, prev
);
2855 if (prev
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2856 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2858 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2859 XSetClipMask (prev
->display
, prev
->gc
, None
);
2861 prev
->num_clips
= 0;
2867 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2869 for (next
= s
->next
; next
; next
= next
->next
)
2870 if (next
->hl
!= s
->hl
2871 && next
->x
- next
->left_overhang
< s
->x
+ s
->width
)
2873 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2874 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2875 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= next
->hl
;
2878 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2879 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, next
);
2880 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2881 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2883 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2884 XSetClipMask (next
->display
, next
->gc
, None
);
2886 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2887 next
->clip_head
= s
->next
;
2892 /* Reset clipping. */
2893 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2897 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2900 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
, int shift_by
)
2902 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
2903 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
2904 x
, y
, width
, height
,
2908 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2912 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*f
, register int n
)
2918 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2919 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2922 x_clear_area (Display
*dpy
, Window window
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
)
2924 eassert (width
> 0 && height
> 0);
2925 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, x
, y
, width
, height
, False
);
2929 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2932 x_clear_frame (struct frame
*f
)
2934 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2936 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f
)));
2940 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
2942 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2943 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2944 x_scroll_bar_clear (f
);
2946 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2947 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2948 redisplay, do it here. */
2949 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
2950 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
2953 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
2958 /* RIF: Show hourglass cursor on frame F. */
2961 x_show_hourglass (struct frame
*f
)
2963 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
2967 struct x_output
*x
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
);
2968 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
2971 if (FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
))
2976 if (!x
->hourglass_window
)
2978 unsigned long mask
= CWCursor
;
2979 XSetWindowAttributes attrs
;
2981 Window parent
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
2983 Window parent
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
2985 attrs
.cursor
= x
->hourglass_cursor
;
2987 x
->hourglass_window
= XCreateWindow
2988 (dpy
, parent
, 0, 0, 32000, 32000, 0, 0,
2989 InputOnly
, CopyFromParent
, mask
, &attrs
);
2992 XMapRaised (dpy
, x
->hourglass_window
);
2998 /* RIF: Cancel hourglass cursor on frame F. */
3001 x_hide_hourglass (struct frame
*f
)
3003 struct x_output
*x
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
);
3005 /* Watch out for newly created frames. */
3006 if (x
->hourglass_window
)
3008 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), x
->hourglass_window
);
3009 /* Sync here because XTread_socket looks at the
3010 hourglass_p flag that is reset to zero below. */
3011 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
3016 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3019 XTflash (struct frame
*f
)
3025 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3026 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3027 GdkWindow
*window
= gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
3029 cairo_t
*cr
= gdk_cairo_create (window
);
3030 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr
, 1, 1, 1);
3031 cairo_set_operator (cr
, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE
);
3032 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3034 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3038 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3041 vals
.foreground
.pixel
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3042 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3043 vals
.function
= GDK_XOR
;
3044 gc
= gdk_gc_new_with_values (window
,
3045 &vals
, GDK_GC_FUNCTION
| GDK_GC_FOREGROUND
);
3046 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3047 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3048 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3049 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3052 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3053 pixels into background pixels. */
3057 values
.function
= GXxor
;
3058 values
.foreground
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3059 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3061 gc
= XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3062 GCFunction
| GCForeground
, &values
);
3066 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3067 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
3068 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3069 int flash_height
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
3070 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3071 int flash_left
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3072 int flash_right
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3073 int width
= flash_right
- flash_left
;
3075 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3076 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3078 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3080 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3081 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3082 width
, flash_height
);
3083 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3085 (height
- flash_height
3086 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3087 width
, flash_height
);
3091 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3092 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3093 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3094 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3099 struct timespec delay
= make_timespec (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3100 struct timespec wakeup
= timespec_add (current_timespec (), delay
);
3102 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3104 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3106 struct timespec current
= current_timespec ();
3107 struct timespec timeout
;
3109 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3110 if (timespec_cmp (wakeup
, current
) <= 0)
3113 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3114 timeout
= make_timespec (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3116 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3117 pselect (0, NULL
, NULL
, NULL
, &timeout
, NULL
);
3121 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3122 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3124 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3126 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3127 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3128 width
, flash_height
);
3129 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3131 (height
- flash_height
3132 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3133 width
, flash_height
);
3136 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3137 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3138 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3139 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3145 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc
));
3147 #undef XFillRectangle
3149 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
);
3160 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (struct frame
*f
, int invisible
)
3163 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->toggle_visible_pointer (f
, invisible
);
3168 /* Make audible bell. */
3171 XTring_bell (struct frame
*f
)
3173 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))
3181 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, 0, None
);
3183 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), 0);
3185 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3191 /***********************************************************************
3193 ***********************************************************************/
3195 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3196 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3199 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*f
, int vpos
, int n
)
3205 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3208 x_scroll_run (struct window
*w
, struct run
*run
)
3210 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
3211 int x
, y
, width
, height
, from_y
, to_y
, bottom_y
;
3213 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3214 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3216 window_box (w
, ANY_AREA
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
);
3218 from_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->current_y
);
3219 to_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->desired_y
);
3220 bottom_y
= y
+ height
;
3224 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3225 line at the bottom. */
3226 if (from_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3227 height
= bottom_y
- from_y
;
3229 height
= run
->height
;
3233 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3235 if (to_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3236 height
= bottom_y
- to_y
;
3238 height
= run
->height
;
3243 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3246 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
3247 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3248 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
3258 /***********************************************************************
3260 ***********************************************************************/
3264 frame_highlight (struct frame
*f
)
3266 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3267 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3268 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3269 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3271 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3272 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3273 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3274 because of this (bug#9310). */
3275 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3276 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3277 f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
3278 x_uncatch_errors ();
3280 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3281 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3285 frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*f
)
3287 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3288 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3289 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3290 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3292 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3293 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3294 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3295 f
->output_data
.x
->border_tile
);
3296 x_uncatch_errors ();
3298 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3299 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3302 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3303 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3304 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3305 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3306 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3309 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
)
3311 struct frame
*old_focus
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3313 if (frame
!= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3315 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3316 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3317 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= frame
;
3319 if (old_focus
&& old_focus
->auto_lower
)
3320 x_lower_frame (old_focus
);
3322 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
&& dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
->auto_raise
)
3323 dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3325 dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
= NULL
;
3328 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo
);
3331 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3332 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3333 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3336 x_focus_changed (int type
, int state
, struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3338 if (type
== FocusIn
)
3340 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
!= frame
)
3342 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, frame
);
3343 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= frame
;
3345 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3346 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3347 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3348 bufp
->arg
= (((NILP (Vterminal_frame
)
3349 || ! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (Vterminal_frame
))
3350 || EQ (Fdaemonp (), Qt
))
3351 && CONSP (Vframe_list
)
3352 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
3354 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_IN_EVENT
;
3355 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3358 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
|= state
;
3361 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3362 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3365 else if (type
== FocusOut
)
3367 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
&= ~state
;
3369 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
== frame
)
3371 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
3372 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, 0);
3374 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_OUT_EVENT
;
3375 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3379 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3380 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3382 if (frame
->pointer_invisible
)
3383 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame
, 0);
3387 /* Return the Emacs frame-object corresponding to an X window.
3388 It could be the frame's main window or an icon window. */
3390 static struct frame
*
3391 x_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int wdesc
)
3393 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
3399 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3402 if (!FRAME_X_P (f
) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) != dpyinfo
)
3404 if (f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_window
== wdesc
)
3406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3407 if ((f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
3408 && XtWindow (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
) == wdesc
)
3409 /* A tooltip frame? */
3410 || (!f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
3411 && FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == wdesc
)
3412 || f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
== wdesc
)
3414 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3416 if (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
)
3418 GtkWidget
*gwdesc
= xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo
->display
, wdesc
);
3419 struct x_output
*x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
3420 if (gwdesc
!= 0 && gwdesc
== x
->edit_widget
)
3423 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3424 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == wdesc
3425 || f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
== wdesc
)
3427 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3432 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
3434 /* Like x_window_to_frame but also compares the window with the widget's
3437 static struct frame
*
3438 x_any_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int wdesc
)
3440 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
3441 struct frame
*f
, *found
= NULL
;
3447 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3452 if (FRAME_X_P (f
) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
)
3454 /* This frame matches if the window is any of its widgets. */
3455 x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
3456 if (x
->hourglass_window
== wdesc
)
3461 GtkWidget
*gwdesc
= xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo
->display
, wdesc
);
3463 && gtk_widget_get_toplevel (gwdesc
) == x
->widget
)
3466 if (wdesc
== XtWindow (x
->widget
)
3467 || wdesc
== XtWindow (x
->column_widget
)
3468 || wdesc
== XtWindow (x
->edit_widget
))
3470 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
3471 else if (lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc
, x
->menubar_widget
))
3475 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == wdesc
)
3476 /* A tooltip frame. */
3484 /* Likewise, but consider only the menu bar widget. */
3486 static struct frame
*
3487 x_menubar_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
,
3488 const XEvent
*event
)
3490 Window wdesc
= event
->xany
.window
;
3491 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
3498 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3501 if (!FRAME_X_P (f
) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) != dpyinfo
)
3503 x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
3505 if (x
->menubar_widget
&& xg_event_is_for_menubar (f
, event
))
3508 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
3509 if (x
->menubar_widget
3510 && lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc
, x
->menubar_widget
))
3517 /* Return the frame whose principal (outermost) window is WDESC.
3518 If WDESC is some other (smaller) window, we return 0. */
3521 x_top_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int wdesc
)
3523 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
3530 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3533 if (!FRAME_X_P (f
) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) != dpyinfo
)
3535 x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
3539 /* This frame matches if the window is its topmost widget. */
3541 GtkWidget
*gwdesc
= xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo
->display
, wdesc
);
3542 if (gwdesc
== x
->widget
)
3545 if (wdesc
== XtWindow (x
->widget
))
3549 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == wdesc
)
3550 /* Tooltip frame. */
3556 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT && !USE_GTK */
3558 #define x_any_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
3559 #define x_top_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
3561 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
3563 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3564 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3566 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3569 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
,
3570 const XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3575 switch (event
->type
)
3580 struct frame
*focus_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
;
3582 = focus_frame
? focus_frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
: 0;
3584 if (event
->xcrossing
.detail
!= NotifyInferior
3585 && event
->xcrossing
.focus
3586 && ! (focus_state
& FOCUS_EXPLICIT
))
3587 x_focus_changed ((event
->type
== EnterNotify
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3589 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3595 x_focus_changed (event
->type
,
3596 (event
->xfocus
.detail
== NotifyPointer
?
3597 FOCUS_IMPLICIT
: FOCUS_EXPLICIT
),
3598 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3602 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
3604 enum xembed_message msg
= event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
3605 x_focus_changed ((msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3606 FOCUS_EXPLICIT
, dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3613 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3614 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3617 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3619 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
);
3623 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3624 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3625 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3627 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3628 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3629 the appropriate X display info. */
3632 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*frame
)
3634 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame
));
3638 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3640 struct frame
*old_highlight
= dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
;
3642 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3644 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
3645 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)))
3646 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
))
3647 : dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
);
3648 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
))
3650 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
, Qnil
);
3651 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3655 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
3657 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
!= old_highlight
)
3660 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight
);
3661 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
3662 frame_highlight (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
);
3668 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3670 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3672 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3674 int min_code
, max_code
;
3677 XModifierKeymap
*mods
;
3679 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= 0;
3680 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= 0;
3681 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3682 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
= 0;
3683 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
= 0;
3685 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo
->display
, &min_code
, &max_code
);
3687 syms
= XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo
->display
,
3688 min_code
, max_code
- min_code
+ 1,
3690 mods
= XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo
->display
);
3692 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3693 Alt keysyms are on. */
3695 int row
, col
; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3696 int found_alt_or_meta
;
3698 for (row
= 3; row
< 8; row
++)
3700 found_alt_or_meta
= 0;
3701 for (col
= 0; col
< mods
->max_keypermod
; col
++)
3703 KeyCode code
= mods
->modifiermap
[(row
* mods
->max_keypermod
) + col
];
3705 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3709 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3713 for (code_col
= 0; code_col
< syms_per_code
; code_col
++)
3715 int sym
= syms
[((code
- min_code
) * syms_per_code
) + code_col
];
3721 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3722 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3727 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3728 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3733 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3734 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3735 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3736 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3741 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3742 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3743 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3744 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3748 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3749 if (!found_alt_or_meta
&& ((1 << row
) == LockMask
))
3750 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= LockMask
;
3751 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3752 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3761 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3762 if (! dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3764 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
;
3765 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3768 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3769 make them just meta, not alt. */
3770 if (dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3772 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
&= ~dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
;
3776 XFreeModifiermap (mods
);
3779 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3783 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int state
)
3785 int mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3786 int mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3787 int mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3788 int mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3791 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3792 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_alt
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3793 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3794 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_meta
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3795 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3796 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_hyper
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3797 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3798 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_super
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3800 return ( ((state
& (ShiftMask
| dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
)) ? shift_modifier
: 0)
3801 | ((state
& ControlMask
) ? ctrl_modifier
: 0)
3802 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
) ? mod_meta
: 0)
3803 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
) ? mod_alt
: 0)
3804 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
) ? mod_super
: 0)
3805 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
) ? mod_hyper
: 0));
3809 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, EMACS_INT state
)
3811 EMACS_INT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3812 EMACS_INT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3813 EMACS_INT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3814 EMACS_INT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3818 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3819 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_alt
= XINT (tem
);
3820 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3821 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_meta
= XINT (tem
);
3822 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3823 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_hyper
= XINT (tem
);
3824 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3825 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_super
= XINT (tem
);
3828 return ( ((state
& mod_alt
) ? dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
: 0)
3829 | ((state
& mod_super
) ? dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
: 0)
3830 | ((state
& mod_hyper
) ? dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
: 0)
3831 | ((state
& shift_modifier
) ? ShiftMask
: 0)
3832 | ((state
& ctrl_modifier
) ? ControlMask
: 0)
3833 | ((state
& mod_meta
) ? dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
: 0));
3836 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3839 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym
)
3844 value
= XKeysymToString (keysym
);
3850 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah.
3852 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
3853 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
3854 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
3855 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
3857 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
3859 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
3860 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
3861 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
3862 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
3863 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
3864 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
3865 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
3866 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
3867 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
3870 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3872 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3876 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event
*result
,
3877 const XButtonEvent
*event
,
3880 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3882 result
->kind
= MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT
;
3883 result
->code
= event
->button
- Button1
;
3884 result
->timestamp
= event
->time
;
3885 result
->modifiers
= (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
3887 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
3891 XSETINT (result
->x
, event
->x
);
3892 XSETINT (result
->y
, event
->y
);
3893 XSETFRAME (result
->frame_or_window
, f
);
3898 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3899 The input handler calls this.
3901 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3902 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3903 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3904 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3907 note_mouse_movement (struct frame
*frame
, const XMotionEvent
*event
)
3910 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3912 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame
))
3915 dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame
);
3916 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
3917 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_motion_frame
= frame
;
3918 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_motion_x
= event
->x
;
3919 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_motion_y
= event
->y
;
3921 if (event
->window
!= FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame
))
3923 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3924 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
3925 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, -1, -1);
3926 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
= NULL
;
3931 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3932 r
= &dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph
;
3933 if (frame
!= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
3934 || event
->x
< r
->x
|| event
->x
>= r
->x
+ r
->width
3935 || event
->y
< r
->y
|| event
->y
>= r
->y
+ r
->height
)
3937 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3938 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
3939 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
);
3940 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3941 remember_mouse_glyph (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
, r
);
3942 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
= frame
;
3949 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3950 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3952 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3953 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3954 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3955 position on the scroll bar.
3957 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3958 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3961 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3962 was at this position.
3964 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3966 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3970 XTmouse_position (struct frame
**fp
, int insist
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
3971 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
, Lisp_Object
*y
,
3975 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
);
3979 if (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
&& insist
== 0)
3981 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
3983 if (bar
->horizontal
)
3984 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, timestamp
);
3986 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, timestamp
);
3993 Window dummy_window
;
3996 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
3998 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3999 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
4000 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
4001 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
))
4002 XFRAME (frame
)->mouse_moved
= 0;
4004 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
4006 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
4007 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
4008 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)),
4010 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
4013 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
4014 a different screen. */
4017 /* The position on that root window. */
4020 /* More trash we can't trust. */
4023 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
4025 (unsigned int *) &dummy
);
4027 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
4028 containing the pointer. */
4032 int parent_x
= 0, parent_y
= 0;
4036 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
4037 structure is changing at the same time this function
4038 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
4040 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
));
4042 if (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo
))
4044 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
4045 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
4046 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
4052 FRAME_X_WINDOW (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
),
4054 /* From-position, to-position. */
4055 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
4059 f1
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
;
4065 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
4067 /* From-window, to-window. */
4070 /* From-position, to-position. */
4071 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
4076 if (child
== None
|| child
== win
)
4079 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4080 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4081 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4082 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4083 if (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, win
))
4091 /* Now we know that:
4092 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4093 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4094 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4095 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4096 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4097 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4098 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4099 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4100 never use them in that case.) */
4103 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4104 want the edit window. */
4105 f1
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, win
);
4107 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4108 f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, win
);
4111 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4112 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4115 && f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
4116 && win
== XtWindow (f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
))
4118 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4121 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)))
4124 x_uncatch_errors ();
4126 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4129 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4131 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
), win
, 2);
4135 f1
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4141 if (f1
== 0 && insist
> 0)
4142 f1
= SELECTED_FRAME ();
4146 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4147 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4148 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4149 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4150 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4151 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4152 the frame are divided into. */
4154 /* FIXME: what if F1 is not an X frame? */
4155 dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f1
);
4156 remember_mouse_glyph (f1
, win_x
, win_y
, &dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph
);
4157 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
= f1
;
4160 *part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4162 XSETINT (*x
, win_x
);
4163 XSETINT (*y
, win_y
);
4164 *timestamp
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
;
4174 /***********************************************************************
4176 ***********************************************************************/
4178 /* Scroll bar support. */
4180 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4182 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4185 static struct scroll_bar
*
4186 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*display
, Window window_id
, int type
)
4188 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
4190 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4191 window_id
= (Window
) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display
, window_id
);
4192 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4194 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
4196 Lisp_Object bar
, condemned
;
4198 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
4201 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4203 condemned
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4204 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4205 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4206 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4207 ! NILP (bar
) || (bar
= condemned
,
4210 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
4211 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
== window_id
4212 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == display
4214 || (type
== 1 && XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->horizontal
)
4215 || (type
== 0 && !XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->horizontal
)))
4216 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
4223 #if defined USE_LUCID
4225 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4226 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4229 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window
)
4231 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
4233 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
4234 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
4236 Widget menu_bar
= XFRAME (frame
)->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
;
4238 if (menu_bar
&& xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar
, window
))
4244 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4247 /************************************************************************
4249 ************************************************************************/
4251 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4253 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object
, enum scroll_bar_part
,
4256 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4257 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4259 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled
;
4261 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4262 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4265 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4267 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id
;
4268 static XtActionHookId horizontal_action_hook_id
;
4270 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll
;
4272 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4273 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4274 to avoid jerkiness. */
4276 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top
;
4278 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4279 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4280 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4281 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4284 xt_action_hook (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, String action_name
,
4285 XEvent
*event
, String
*params
, Cardinal
*num_params
)
4288 const char *end_action
;
4291 scroll_bar_p
= XmIsScrollBar (widget
);
4292 end_action
= "Release";
4293 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4294 scroll_bar_p
= XtIsSubclass (widget
, scrollbarWidgetClass
);
4295 end_action
= "EndScroll";
4296 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4299 && strcmp (action_name
, end_action
) == 0
4300 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4303 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4305 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4306 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0, 0);
4307 w
= XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled
);
4308 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
4310 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
4313 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4314 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w
);
4316 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4317 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
4318 bar
->last_seen_part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
4320 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4321 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 0;
4327 xt_horizontal_action_hook (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, String action_name
,
4328 XEvent
*event
, String
*params
, Cardinal
*num_params
)
4331 const char *end_action
;
4334 scroll_bar_p
= XmIsScrollBar (widget
);
4335 end_action
= "Release";
4336 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4337 scroll_bar_p
= XtIsSubclass (widget
, scrollbarWidgetClass
);
4338 end_action
= "EndScroll";
4339 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4342 && strcmp (action_name
, end_action
) == 0
4343 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4346 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4348 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4349 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0, 1);
4350 w
= XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled
);
4351 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
);
4353 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
4356 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4357 set_horizontal_scroll_bar (w
);
4359 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4360 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
4361 bar
->last_seen_part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
4363 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4364 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 0;
4367 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4369 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4370 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4371 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4372 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4375 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window
, enum scroll_bar_part part
,
4376 int portion
, int whole
, bool horizontal
)
4379 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= &event
.xclient
;
4380 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (window
);
4381 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4382 intptr_t iw
= (intptr_t) w
;
4383 enum { BITS_PER_INTPTR
= CHAR_BIT
* sizeof iw
};
4384 verify (BITS_PER_INTPTR
<= 64);
4385 int sign_shift
= BITS_PER_INTPTR
- 32;
4389 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4390 ev
->type
= ClientMessage
;
4391 ev
->message_type
= (horizontal
4392 ? FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
4393 : FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_Scrollbar
);
4394 ev
->display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
4395 ev
->window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
4398 /* A 32-bit X client on a 64-bit X server can pass a window pointer
4399 as-is. A 64-bit client on a 32-bit X server is in trouble
4400 because a pointer does not fit and would be truncated while
4401 passing through the server. So use two slots and hope that X12
4402 will resolve such issues someday. */
4403 ev
->data
.l
[0] = iw
>> 31 >> 1;
4404 ev
->data
.l
[1] = sign_shift
<= 0 ? iw
: iw
<< sign_shift
>> sign_shift
;
4405 ev
->data
.l
[2] = part
;
4406 ev
->data
.l
[3] = portion
;
4407 ev
->data
.l
[4] = whole
;
4409 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4410 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4411 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 1;
4412 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4415 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4416 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4417 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4418 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), False
, 0, &event
);
4423 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4427 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent
*event
,
4428 struct input_event
*ievent
)
4430 const XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= &event
->xclient
;
4434 /* See the comment in the function above. */
4435 intptr_t iw0
= ev
->data
.l
[0];
4436 intptr_t iw1
= ev
->data
.l
[1];
4437 intptr_t iw
= (iw0
<< 31 << 1) + (iw1
& 0xffffffffu
);
4438 w
= (struct window
*) iw
;
4440 XSETWINDOW (window
, w
);
4442 ievent
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
4443 ievent
->frame_or_window
= window
;
4446 ievent
->timestamp
= CurrentTime
;
4449 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w
->frame
)));
4452 ievent
->part
= ev
->data
.l
[2];
4453 ievent
->x
= make_number (ev
->data
.l
[3]);
4454 ievent
->y
= make_number (ev
->data
.l
[4]);
4455 ievent
->modifiers
= 0;
4458 /* Transform a horizontal scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs
4459 input event in *IEVENT. */
4462 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent
*event
,
4463 struct input_event
*ievent
)
4465 const XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= &event
->xclient
;
4469 /* See the comment in the function above. */
4470 intptr_t iw0
= ev
->data
.l
[0];
4471 intptr_t iw1
= ev
->data
.l
[1];
4472 intptr_t iw
= (iw0
<< 31 << 1) + (iw1
& 0xffffffffu
);
4473 w
= (struct window
*) iw
;
4475 XSETWINDOW (window
, w
);
4477 ievent
->kind
= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
4478 ievent
->frame_or_window
= window
;
4481 ievent
->timestamp
= CurrentTime
;
4484 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w
->frame
)));
4487 ievent
->part
= ev
->data
.l
[2];
4488 ievent
->x
= make_number (ev
->data
.l
[3]);
4489 ievent
->y
= make_number (ev
->data
.l
[4]);
4490 ievent
->modifiers
= 0;
4496 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4498 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4500 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4501 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4502 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4505 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4507 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4508 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*cs
= call_data
;
4509 enum scroll_bar_part part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
4510 int horizontal
= bar
->horizontal
, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4514 case XmCR_DECREMENT
:
4516 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_left_arrow
: scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4519 case XmCR_INCREMENT
:
4521 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_right_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4524 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT
:
4526 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_before_handle
: scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4529 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT
:
4531 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_after_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4536 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_to_leftmost
: scroll_bar_to_top
;
4539 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM
:
4541 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_to_rightmost
: scroll_bar_to_bottom
;
4549 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XmNsliderSize
, &slider_size
, NULL
);
4554 portion
= bar
->whole
* ((float)cs
->value
/ XM_SB_MAX
);
4555 whole
= bar
->whole
* ((float)(XM_SB_MAX
- slider_size
) / XM_SB_MAX
);
4556 portion
= min (portion
, whole
);
4557 part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
4561 whole
= XM_SB_MAX
- slider_size
;
4562 portion
= min (cs
->value
, whole
);
4563 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4566 bar
->dragging
= cs
->value
;
4570 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED
:
4574 if (part
!= scroll_bar_nowhere
)
4576 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4577 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
, bar
->horizontal
);
4581 #elif defined USE_GTK
4583 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4584 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4587 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange
*range
,
4588 GtkScrollType scroll
,
4592 int whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4593 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= user_data
;
4594 enum scroll_bar_part part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
4595 GtkAdjustment
*adj
= GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range
));
4596 struct frame
*f
= g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range
), XG_FRAME_DATA
);
4598 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar
) return FALSE
;
4602 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP
:
4603 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4604 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
!= 0
4605 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
< (1 << 4))
4607 if (bar
->horizontal
)
4609 part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
4610 whole
= (int)(gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj
) -
4611 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj
));
4612 portion
= min ((int)value
, whole
);
4613 bar
->dragging
= portion
;
4617 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4618 whole
= gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj
) -
4619 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj
);
4620 portion
= min ((int)value
, whole
);
4621 bar
->dragging
= portion
;
4625 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD
:
4626 part
= (bar
->horizontal
4627 ? scroll_bar_left_arrow
: scroll_bar_up_arrow
);
4630 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD
:
4631 part
= (bar
->horizontal
4632 ? scroll_bar_right_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
);
4635 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD
:
4636 part
= (bar
->horizontal
4637 ? scroll_bar_before_handle
: scroll_bar_above_handle
);
4640 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD
:
4641 part
= (bar
->horizontal
4642 ? scroll_bar_after_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
);
4647 if (part
!= scroll_bar_nowhere
)
4649 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4650 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
, bar
->horizontal
);
4656 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to -1 when dragging is done. */
4659 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget
*widget
,
4660 GdkEventButton
*event
,
4663 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= user_data
;
4665 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4667 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4668 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0, bar
->horizontal
);
4669 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4676 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4678 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4679 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4680 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4684 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4686 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4687 float *top_addr
= call_data
;
4688 float top
= *top_addr
;
4690 int whole
, portion
, height
, width
;
4691 enum scroll_bar_part part
;
4692 int horizontal
= bar
->horizontal
;
4697 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4699 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNshown
, &shown
, XtNwidth
, &width
, NULL
);
4704 whole
= bar
->whole
- (shown
* bar
->whole
);
4705 portion
= min (top
* bar
->whole
, whole
);
4713 part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
4717 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4719 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNshown
, &shown
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4723 portion
= shown
< 1 ? top
* whole
: 0;
4725 if (shown
< 1 && (eabs (top
+ shown
- 1) < 1.0f
/ height
))
4726 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4727 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4728 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4729 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4731 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4733 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4736 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4737 bar
->dragging
= portion
;
4738 bar
->last_seen_part
= part
;
4739 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
, bar
->horizontal
);
4743 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4744 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4745 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4746 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4747 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4748 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4749 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4752 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4754 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4755 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4756 int position
= (intptr_t) call_data
;
4757 Dimension height
, width
;
4758 enum scroll_bar_part part
;
4760 if (bar
->horizontal
)
4762 /* Get the width of the scroll bar. */
4764 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNwidth
, &width
, NULL
);
4767 if (eabs (position
) >= width
)
4768 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_before_handle
: scroll_bar_after_handle
;
4770 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4771 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4772 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
&& eabs (position
) <= max (5, width
/ 20))
4773 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_left_arrow
: scroll_bar_right_arrow
;
4775 part
= scroll_bar_move_ratio
;
4777 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4779 bar
->last_seen_part
= part
;
4780 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, position
, width
, bar
->horizontal
);
4785 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4787 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4790 if (eabs (position
) >= height
)
4791 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4793 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4794 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4795 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
&& eabs (position
) <= max (5, height
/ 20))
4796 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4798 part
= scroll_bar_move_ratio
;
4800 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4802 bar
->last_seen_part
= part
;
4803 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, position
, height
, bar
->horizontal
);
4807 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4809 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4810 #define SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME "horizontalScrollBar"
4812 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4813 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4817 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4819 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4822 xg_create_scroll_bar (f
, bar
, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback
),
4823 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback
),
4829 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4831 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME
;
4834 xg_create_horizontal_scroll_bar (f
, bar
, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback
),
4835 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback
),
4840 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4843 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4849 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4850 unsigned long pixel
;
4855 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4856 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4857 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNminimum
, 0); ++ac
;
4858 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNmaximum
, XM_SB_MAX
); ++ac
;
4859 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNorientation
, XmVERTICAL
); ++ac
;
4860 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNprocessingDirection
, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM
), ++ac
;
4861 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNincrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4862 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNpageIncrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4864 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4867 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNforeground
, pixel
);
4871 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4874 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNbackground
, pixel
);
4878 widget
= XmCreateScrollBar (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
,
4879 (char *) scroll_bar_name
, av
, ac
);
4881 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4882 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4884 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdragCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4886 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNincrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4888 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageDecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4890 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageIncrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4892 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoBottomCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4894 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoTopCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4897 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4898 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4900 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4901 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4902 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget
), XtWindow (widget
),
4903 f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
4905 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4907 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4908 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4909 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4910 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4911 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4912 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNorientation
, XtorientVertical
); ++ac
;
4913 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4914 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4916 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4919 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNforeground
, pixel
);
4923 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4926 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbackground
, pixel
);
4930 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4932 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4933 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4935 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4938 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4939 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4940 &pixel
, 1.2, 0x8000))
4942 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4945 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4947 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4950 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4951 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4952 &pixel
, 0.6, 0x4000))
4954 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4958 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4959 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4960 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1
4961 || f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4962 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4963 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4964 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4967 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
,
4968 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
)) < 16);
4972 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4973 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4974 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4976 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4978 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, False
);
4981 /* Specify the colors. */
4982 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
;
4985 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNtopShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4988 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
;
4991 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbottomShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4997 widget
= XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name
, scrollbarWidgetClass
,
4998 f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, av
, ac
);
5001 char const *initial
= "";
5002 char const *val
= initial
;
5003 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNscrollVCursor
, (XtPointer
) &val
,
5004 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5005 XtNarrowScrollbars
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll
,
5007 XtNpickTop
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_pick_top
, NULL
);
5008 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
|| val
== initial
)
5009 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5010 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= True
;
5011 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5012 XtVaSetValues (widget
, XtNcursorName
, "top_left_arrow", NULL
);
5016 /* Define callbacks. */
5017 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNjumpProc
, xaw_jump_callback
, (XtPointer
) bar
);
5018 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNscrollProc
, xaw_scroll_callback
,
5021 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5022 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
5024 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5026 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5027 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5028 if (action_hook_id
== 0)
5029 action_hook_id
= XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con
, xt_action_hook
, 0);
5031 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5032 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar
, widget
);
5033 xwindow
= XtWindow (widget
);
5034 bar
->x_window
= xwindow
;
5036 bar
->horizontal
= 0;
5042 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
5048 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME
;
5049 unsigned long pixel
;
5054 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
5055 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
5056 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNminimum
, 0); ++ac
;
5057 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNmaximum
, XM_SB_MAX
); ++ac
;
5058 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNorientation
, XmHORIZONTAL
); ++ac
;
5059 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNprocessingDirection
, XmMAX_ON_RIGHT
), ++ac
;
5060 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNincrement
, 1); ++ac
;
5061 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNpageIncrement
, 1); ++ac
;
5063 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
5066 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNforeground
, pixel
);
5070 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5073 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNbackground
, pixel
);
5077 widget
= XmCreateScrollBar (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
,
5078 (char *) scroll_bar_name
, av
, ac
);
5080 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
5081 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5083 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdragCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5085 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNincrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5087 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageDecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5089 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageIncrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5091 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoBottomCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5093 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoTopCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5096 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5097 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
5099 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
5100 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
5101 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget
), XtWindow (widget
),
5102 f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
5104 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5106 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
5107 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
5108 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
5109 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
5110 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
5111 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNorientation
, XtorientHorizontal
); ++ac
;
5112 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
5113 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
5115 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
5118 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNforeground
, pixel
);
5122 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5125 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbackground
, pixel
);
5129 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
5131 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
5132 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1)
5134 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5137 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5138 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
5139 &pixel
, 1.2, 0x8000))
5141 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
5144 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
5146 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5149 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5150 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
5151 &pixel
, 0.6, 0x4000))
5153 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
5157 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
5158 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
5159 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1
5160 || f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
5161 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
5162 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
5163 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
5166 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
,
5167 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
)) < 16);
5171 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
5172 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
5173 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
5175 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
5177 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, False
);
5180 /* Specify the colors. */
5181 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
;
5184 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNtopShadowPixel
, pixel
);
5187 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
;
5190 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbottomShadowPixel
, pixel
);
5196 widget
= XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name
, scrollbarWidgetClass
,
5197 f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, av
, ac
);
5200 char const *initial
= "";
5201 char const *val
= initial
;
5202 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNscrollVCursor
, (XtPointer
) &val
,
5203 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5204 XtNarrowScrollbars
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll
,
5206 XtNpickTop
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_pick_top
, NULL
);
5207 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
|| val
== initial
)
5208 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5209 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= True
;
5210 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5211 XtVaSetValues (widget
, XtNcursorName
, "top_left_arrow", NULL
);
5215 /* Define callbacks. */
5216 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNjumpProc
, xaw_jump_callback
, (XtPointer
) bar
);
5217 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNscrollProc
, xaw_scroll_callback
,
5220 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5221 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
5223 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5225 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5226 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5227 if (horizontal_action_hook_id
== 0)
5228 horizontal_action_hook_id
5229 = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con
, xt_horizontal_action_hook
, 0);
5231 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5232 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar
, widget
);
5233 xwindow
= XtWindow (widget
);
5234 bar
->x_window
= xwindow
;
5236 bar
->horizontal
= 1;
5240 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5243 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
5244 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
5248 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
, int whole
)
5250 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5254 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
, int whole
)
5256 xg_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5259 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5261 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
,
5264 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5265 Widget widget
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
5272 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p
)
5274 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
5275 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
5276 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
5277 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
5278 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
5279 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
5280 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
5281 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
5282 its size, the update will often happen too late.
5283 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
5284 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
5285 portion
= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)) * 30;
5286 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
5287 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
5295 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
5296 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
5299 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5303 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
5304 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
5306 size
= clip_to_bounds (1, shown
* XM_SB_MAX
, XM_SB_MAX
);
5308 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
5309 value
= top
* XM_SB_MAX
;
5310 value
= min (value
, XM_SB_MAX
- size
);
5312 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget
, value
, size
, 0, 0, False
);
5314 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5320 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
5321 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
5325 float old_top
, old_shown
;
5327 XtVaGetValues (widget
,
5328 XtNtopOfThumb
, &old_top
,
5329 XtNshown
, &old_shown
,
5333 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5334 if (bar
->dragging
== -1 || bar
->last_seen_part
== scroll_bar_down_arrow
)
5335 top
= max (0, min (1, top
));
5338 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5339 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
5340 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
5341 top
= min (top
, 0.99f
);
5343 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5344 shown
= max (0, min (1 - top
- (2.0f
/ height
), shown
));
5345 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5346 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
5347 shown
= max (shown
, 0.01f
);
5350 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
5351 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
5352 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
5353 if (top
!= old_top
|| shown
!= old_shown
)
5355 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5356 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5359 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5360 if (!xaw3d_pick_top
)
5361 shown
= min (shown
, old_shown
);
5363 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5367 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5373 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
,
5376 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5377 Widget widget
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
5384 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
5385 top
= (float) position
/ (whole
- portion
);
5387 int size
= clip_to_bounds (1, shown
* XM_SB_MAX
, XM_SB_MAX
);
5388 int value
= clip_to_bounds (0, top
* (XM_SB_MAX
- size
), XM_SB_MAX
- size
);
5390 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget
, value
, size
, 0, 0, False
);
5392 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5398 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
5399 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
5403 float old_top
, old_shown
;
5405 XtVaGetValues (widget
,
5406 XtNtopOfThumb
, &old_top
,
5407 XtNshown
, &old_shown
,
5412 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5413 if (bar
->dragging
== -1 || bar
->last_seen_part
== scroll_bar_down_arrow
)
5414 top
= max (0, min (1, top
));
5417 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5418 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
5419 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
5420 top
= min (top
, 0.99f
);
5422 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5423 shown
= max (0, min (1 - top
- (2.0f
/ height
), shown
));
5424 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5425 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
5426 shown
= max (shown
, 0.01f
);
5430 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
5431 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
5432 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
5433 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5435 if (top
!= old_top
|| shown
!= old_shown
)
5437 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5438 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5441 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5442 if (!xaw3d_pick_top
)
5443 shown
= min (shown
, old_shown
);
5445 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5450 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5454 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5456 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5460 /************************************************************************
5461 Scroll bars, general
5462 ************************************************************************/
5464 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
5465 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
5466 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
5469 static struct scroll_bar
*
5470 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window
*w
, int top
, int left
, int width
, int height
, bool horizontal
)
5472 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5473 struct scroll_bar
*bar
5474 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar
, x_window
, PVEC_OTHER
);
5479 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5481 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
);
5483 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
);
5484 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5486 XSetWindowAttributes a
;
5490 a
.background_pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5491 if (a
.background_pixel
== -1)
5492 a
.background_pixel
= FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
);
5494 a
.event_mask
= (ButtonPressMask
| ButtonReleaseMask
5495 | ButtonMotionMask
| PointerMotionHintMask
5497 a
.cursor
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
;
5499 mask
= (CWBackPixel
| CWEventMask
| CWCursor
);
5501 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
5502 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
5503 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
5504 if (width
> 0 && window_box_height (w
) > 0)
5505 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5506 left
, top
, width
, window_box_height (w
));
5508 window
= XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5509 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
5510 left
, top
, width
, height
,
5511 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
5518 bar
->x_window
= window
;
5520 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5522 XSETWINDOW (bar
->window
, w
);
5526 bar
->height
= height
;
5530 bar
->horizontal
= horizontal
;
5531 #if defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS) && defined (USE_LUCID)
5532 bar
->last_seen_part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
5535 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5536 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5538 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
5539 fset_scroll_bars (f
, barobj
);
5540 if (!NILP (bar
->next
))
5541 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
5543 /* Map the window/widget. */
5544 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5548 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f
, bar
->x_window
, top
,
5549 left
, width
, max (height
, 1));
5551 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
, bar
->x_window
, top
,
5552 left
, width
, max (height
, 1));
5553 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5554 Widget scroll_bar
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
5555 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar
, left
, top
, width
, max (height
, 1), 0);
5556 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar
);
5557 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5559 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5560 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
5561 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5568 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5570 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5572 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5573 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5574 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5577 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5578 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5579 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5580 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5581 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5584 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int start
, int end
, int rebuild
)
5586 bool dragging
= bar
->dragging
!= -1;
5587 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5588 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5589 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
5591 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5593 && start
== bar
->start
5600 int inside_width
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f
, bar
->width
);
5601 int inside_height
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f
, bar
->height
);
5602 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5604 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5605 the distance between start and end. */
5607 int length
= end
- start
;
5611 else if (start
> top_range
)
5613 end
= start
+ length
;
5617 else if (end
> top_range
&& ! dragging
)
5621 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5625 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5626 if (end
> top_range
)
5629 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5630 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5631 that many pixels tall. */
5632 end
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
;
5634 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5635 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5636 if ((inside_width
> 0) && (start
> 0))
5637 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5638 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5639 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
,
5640 inside_width
, start
);
5642 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5643 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5644 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5645 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5647 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5648 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5649 /* x, y, width, height */
5650 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5651 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ start
,
5652 inside_width
, end
- start
);
5654 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5655 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5656 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5657 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5659 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5660 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5661 if ((inside_width
> 0) && (end
< inside_height
))
5662 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5663 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5664 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ end
,
5665 inside_width
, inside_height
- end
);
5671 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5673 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5677 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
5679 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5682 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5684 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f
, bar
->x_window
);
5685 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5686 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
));
5687 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5689 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
5692 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5693 if (bar
->horizontal
)
5694 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar
->window
), Qnil
);
5696 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar
->window
), Qnil
);
5702 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5703 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5704 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5708 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
, int portion
, int whole
, int position
)
5710 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5712 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5713 int top
, height
, left
, width
;
5714 int window_y
, window_height
;
5716 /* Get window dimensions. */
5717 window_box (w
, ANY_AREA
, 0, &window_y
, 0, &window_height
);
5719 height
= window_height
;
5720 left
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
5721 width
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w
);
5723 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5724 if (NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5726 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5729 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5730 left
, top
, width
, height
);
5734 bar
= x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, left
, width
, max (height
, 1), 0);
5738 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5739 unsigned int mask
= 0;
5741 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5745 if (left
!= bar
->left
)
5747 if (top
!= bar
->top
)
5749 if (width
!= bar
->width
)
5751 if (height
!= bar
->height
)
5754 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5756 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5759 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5760 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5761 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5762 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5763 left
, top
, width
, height
);
5765 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
, bar
->x_window
, top
,
5766 left
, width
, max (height
, 1));
5767 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5768 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
),
5769 left
, top
, width
, max (height
, 1), 0);
5770 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5772 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5774 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5783 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
,
5787 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5789 /* Remember new settings. */
5793 bar
->height
= height
;
5798 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5799 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5800 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5801 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5803 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5805 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, height
);
5808 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, 0, top_range
, 0);
5811 int start
= ((double) position
* top_range
) / whole
;
5812 int end
= ((double) (position
+ portion
) * top_range
) / whole
;
5813 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, 0);
5816 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5818 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
5819 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w
, barobj
);
5824 XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
, int portion
, int whole
, int position
)
5826 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5828 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5829 int top
, height
, left
, width
;
5830 int window_x
, window_width
;
5831 int pixel_width
= WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w
);
5833 /* Get window dimensions. */
5834 window_box (w
, ANY_AREA
, &window_x
, 0, &window_width
, 0);
5836 width
= window_width
;
5837 top
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_Y (w
);
5838 height
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_HEIGHT (w
);
5840 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5841 if (NILP (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
))
5843 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5847 /* Clear also part between window_width and
5848 WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH. */
5849 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5850 left
, top
, pixel_width
, height
);
5854 bar
= x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, left
, width
, height
, 1);
5858 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5859 unsigned int mask
= 0;
5861 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
);
5865 if (left
!= bar
->left
)
5867 if (top
!= bar
->top
)
5869 if (width
!= bar
->width
)
5871 if (height
!= bar
->height
)
5874 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5875 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5878 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5879 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5880 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5881 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5882 WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w
), top
,
5883 pixel_width
- WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w
), height
);
5885 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f
, bar
->x_window
, top
, left
,
5887 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5888 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
),
5889 left
, top
, width
, height
, 0);
5890 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5892 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5894 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5895 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5896 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5899 int area_height
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_HEIGHT (w
);
5900 int rest
= area_height
- height
;
5901 if (rest
> 0 && width
> 0)
5902 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5903 left
, top
, width
, rest
);
5906 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5915 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
,
5919 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5921 /* Remember new settings. */
5925 bar
->height
= height
;
5930 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5931 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5932 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5933 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5935 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5937 int left_range
= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f
, width
);
5940 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, 0, left_range
, 0);
5943 int start
= ((double) position
* left_range
) / whole
;
5944 int end
= ((double) (position
+ portion
) * left_range
) / whole
;
5945 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, 0);
5948 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5950 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
5951 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (w
, barobj
);
5955 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5956 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5957 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5958 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5959 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5960 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5961 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5963 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5964 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5965 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5968 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (struct frame
*frame
)
5970 if (!NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5972 if (!NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5974 /* Prepend scrollbars to already condemned ones. */
5975 Lisp_Object last
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5977 while (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (last
)->next
))
5978 last
= XSCROLL_BAR (last
)->next
;
5980 XSCROLL_BAR (last
)->next
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5981 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
))->prev
= last
;
5984 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame
, FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
));
5985 fset_scroll_bars (frame
, Qnil
);
5990 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5991 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5994 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
)
5996 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
6000 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
6001 if (NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
) && NILP (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
))
6004 if (!NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
) && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w
))
6006 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
6007 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6008 f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
6009 if (NILP (bar
->prev
))
6011 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6013 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
6014 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6016 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
),
6017 w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
6018 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f
, bar
->next
);
6020 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6021 one or the other! */
6025 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->prev
)->next
= bar
->next
;
6027 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
6028 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
= bar
->prev
;
6030 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
6032 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
6033 fset_scroll_bars (f
, barobj
);
6034 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
6035 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
6039 if (!NILP (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
) && WINDOW_HAS_HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR (w
))
6041 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
);
6042 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6043 f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
6044 if (NILP (bar
->prev
))
6046 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6048 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
))
6049 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6051 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
),
6052 w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
))
6053 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f
, bar
->next
);
6055 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6056 one or the other! */
6060 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->prev
)->next
= bar
->next
;
6062 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
6063 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
= bar
->prev
;
6065 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
6067 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
6068 fset_scroll_bars (f
, barobj
);
6069 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
6070 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
6074 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
6075 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
6078 XTjudge_scroll_bars (struct frame
*f
)
6080 Lisp_Object bar
, next
;
6082 bar
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
6084 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
6085 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
6086 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f
, Qnil
);
6088 for (; ! NILP (bar
); bar
= next
)
6090 struct scroll_bar
*b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
6092 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
6095 b
->next
= b
->prev
= Qnil
;
6098 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
6099 and they should get garbage-collected. */
6103 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6104 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
6105 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
6107 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6111 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, const XEvent
*event
)
6113 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
6114 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
6115 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
6119 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, bar
->start
, bar
->end
, 1);
6121 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
6122 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
6123 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
6124 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
6126 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
6127 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
6128 /* x, y, width, height */
6129 0, 0, bar
->width
- 1, bar
->height
- 1);
6131 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
6132 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
6133 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
6134 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
6139 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6141 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
6142 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
6144 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6149 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar
*bar
,
6150 const XEvent
*event
,
6151 struct input_event
*emacs_event
)
6153 if (! WINDOWP (bar
->window
))
6156 emacs_event
->kind
= (bar
->horizontal
6157 ? HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
6158 : SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
);
6159 emacs_event
->code
= event
->xbutton
.button
- Button1
;
6160 emacs_event
->modifiers
6161 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO
6162 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)))),
6163 event
->xbutton
.state
)
6164 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
6167 emacs_event
->frame_or_window
= bar
->window
;
6168 emacs_event
->arg
= Qnil
;
6169 emacs_event
->timestamp
= event
->xbutton
.time
;
6170 if (bar
->horizontal
)
6173 = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f
, bar
->width
);
6174 int x
= event
->xbutton
.x
- HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
;
6177 if (x
> left_range
) x
= left_range
;
6180 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_before_handle
;
6181 else if (x
< bar
->end
+ HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
6182 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
6184 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_after_handle
;
6186 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6187 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
6188 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
&& bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6190 int new_start
= - bar
->dragging
;
6191 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
6193 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
6198 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, left_range
);
6199 XSETINT (emacs_event
->y
, x
);
6204 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
6205 int y
= event
->xbutton
.y
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
6208 if (y
> top_range
) y
= top_range
;
6211 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
6212 else if (y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
6213 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
6215 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
6217 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6218 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
6219 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
&& bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6221 int new_start
= y
- bar
->dragging
;
6222 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
6224 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
6229 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, y
);
6230 XSETINT (emacs_event
->y
, top_range
);
6234 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6236 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
6238 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6242 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar
*bar
,
6243 const XMotionEvent
*event
)
6245 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->frame
);
6246 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
6248 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
6249 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= bar
;
6252 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
6253 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6255 /* Where should the handle be now? */
6256 int new_start
= event
->y
- bar
->dragging
;
6258 if (new_start
!= bar
->start
)
6260 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
6262 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
6267 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6269 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
6270 on the scroll bar. */
6273 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**fp
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
6274 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
,
6275 Lisp_Object
*y
, Time
*timestamp
)
6277 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
);
6278 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
6279 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
6280 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
6282 Window dummy_window
;
6284 unsigned int dummy_mask
;
6288 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
6290 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
6292 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
6293 &dummy_window
, &dummy_window
,
6294 &dummy_coord
, &dummy_coord
,
6296 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
6299 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
6302 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
6304 win_y
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
6306 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6307 win_y
-= bar
->dragging
;
6311 if (win_y
> top_range
)
6315 *bar_window
= bar
->window
;
6317 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6318 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
6319 else if (win_y
< bar
->start
)
6320 *part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
6321 else if (win_y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
6322 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
6324 *part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
6326 XSETINT (*x
, win_y
);
6327 XSETINT (*y
, top_range
);
6330 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
6331 *timestamp
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
;
6338 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
6339 on the scroll bar. */
6342 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**fp
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
6343 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
,
6344 Lisp_Object
*y
, Time
*timestamp
)
6346 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
);
6347 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
6348 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
6349 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
6351 Window dummy_window
;
6353 unsigned int dummy_mask
;
6357 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
6359 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
6361 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
6362 &dummy_window
, &dummy_window
,
6363 &dummy_coord
, &dummy_coord
,
6365 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
6368 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
6371 int left_range
= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f
, bar
->width
);
6373 win_x
-= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
;
6375 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6376 win_x
-= bar
->dragging
;
6380 if (win_x
> left_range
)
6384 *bar_window
= bar
->window
;
6386 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6387 *part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
6388 else if (win_x
< bar
->start
)
6389 *part
= scroll_bar_before_handle
;
6390 else if (win_x
< bar
->end
+ HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
6391 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
6393 *part
= scroll_bar_after_handle
;
6395 XSETINT (*y
, win_x
);
6396 XSETINT (*x
, left_range
);
6399 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
6400 *timestamp
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
;
6407 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
6408 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
6409 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
6413 x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame
*f
)
6415 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6418 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
6419 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
6420 But in that case we should not clear them. */
6421 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
))
6422 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); VECTORP (bar
);
6423 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
6424 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
6425 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
,
6427 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6430 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
6432 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
6433 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
6435 static int temp_index
;
6436 static short temp_buffer
[100];
6438 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
6439 if (temp_index == ARRAYELTS (temp_buffer)) \
6441 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
6443 #else /* not ENABLE_CHECKING */
6445 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) ((void)0)
6447 #endif /* ENABLE_CHECKING */
6449 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
6450 on a particular display. */
6452 static struct x_display_info
*XTread_socket_fake_io_error
;
6454 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
6455 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
6456 We try all the open displays, one by one.
6457 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
6459 static struct x_display_info
*next_noop_dpyinfo
;
6468 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
6469 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
6470 EVENT is the X event to filter.
6472 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
6474 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
6478 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*event
)
6480 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
6481 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
6482 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
6485 struct frame
*f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
6486 event
->xclient
.window
);
6488 return XFilterEvent (event
, f1
? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1
) : None
);
6493 static int current_count
;
6494 static int current_finish
;
6495 static struct input_event
*current_hold_quit
;
6497 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
6498 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
6499 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
6500 static GdkFilterReturn
6501 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent
*gxev
, GdkEvent
*ev
, gpointer data
)
6503 XEvent
*xev
= (XEvent
*) gxev
;
6506 if (current_count
>= 0)
6508 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
6510 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (xev
->xany
.display
);
6513 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
6514 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
6515 so we do it here. */
6516 if ((xev
->type
== KeyPress
|| xev
->type
== KeyRelease
)
6518 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, xev
))
6521 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
6526 current_finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
6529 += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, xev
, ¤t_finish
,
6533 current_finish
= x_dispatch_event (xev
, xev
->xany
.display
);
6537 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
|| current_finish
== X_EVENT_DROP
)
6538 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
6540 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE
;
6542 #endif /* USE_GTK */
6545 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time
,
6546 enum xembed_message
,
6547 long detail
, long data1
, long data2
);
6550 x_net_wm_state (struct frame
*f
, Window window
)
6552 int value
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
6553 Lisp_Object lval
= Qnil
;
6556 (void)get_current_wm_state (f
, window
, &value
, &sticky
);
6560 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
6563 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
6566 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
6569 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
6574 store_frame_param (f
, Qfullscreen
, lval
);
6575 /** store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil); **/
6578 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
6580 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
6581 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
6582 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
6583 *EVENT is unchanged unless we're processing KeyPress event.
6585 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
6588 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
,
6589 const XEvent
*event
,
6590 int *finish
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
6593 struct input_event ie
;
6594 struct selection_input_event sie
;
6598 ptrdiff_t nbytes
= 0;
6599 struct frame
*any
, *f
= NULL
;
6600 struct coding_system coding
;
6601 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
6602 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
6603 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
6604 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
6605 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay. */
6606 static XComposeStatus compose_status
;
6610 *finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
6612 EVENT_INIT (inev
.ie
);
6613 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
;
6616 any
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xany
.window
);
6618 if (any
&& any
->wait_event_type
== event
->type
)
6619 any
->wait_event_type
= 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
6621 switch (event
->type
)
6625 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
6626 && event
->xclient
.format
== 32)
6628 if (event
->xclient
.data
.l
[0] == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
6630 /* Use the value returned by x_any_window_to_frame
6631 because this could be the shell widget window
6632 if the frame has no title bar. */
6635 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
6636 if (f
&& FRAME_XIC (f
))
6637 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f
));
6639 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
6640 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
6641 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
6642 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
6643 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
6646 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
6647 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
6648 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
6649 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
6652 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
6653 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
6654 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
6657 Display
*d
= event
->xclient
.display
;
6658 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
6659 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
6661 XSetInputFocus (d
, event
->xclient
.window
,
6662 /* The ICCCM says this is
6663 the only valid choice. */
6665 event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1]);
6666 /* This is needed to detect the error
6667 if there is an error. */
6669 x_uncatch_errors ();
6671 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
6676 if (event
->xclient
.data
.l
[0] == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
6678 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
6679 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
6680 the session manager, who's looking for such a
6681 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
6682 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
6683 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
6684 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
6685 session manager and one for this. */
6687 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
6690 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
6691 event
->xclient
.window
);
6692 /* This is just so we only give real data once
6693 for a single Emacs process. */
6694 if (f
== SELECTED_FRAME ())
6695 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
6696 event
->xclient
.window
,
6697 initial_argv
, initial_argc
);
6699 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
6700 event
->xclient
.window
,
6706 if (event
->xclient
.data
.l
[0] == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
6710 goto OTHER
; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6712 inev
.ie
.kind
= DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT
;
6713 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6720 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
6723 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
6726 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xclient
.window
);
6728 new_x
= event
->xclient
.data
.s
[0];
6729 new_y
= event
->xclient
.data
.s
[1];
6733 f
->left_pos
= new_x
;
6740 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
)
6744 _XEditResCheckMessages (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
,
6745 NULL
, (XEvent
*) event
, NULL
);
6748 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6750 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
6751 || event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
)
6753 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6754 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6755 currently never do because we are interested in
6756 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6757 Pixmap pixmap
= (Pixmap
) event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
6758 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xclient
.window
);
6761 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap
, f
);
6762 expose_frame (f
, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6766 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6767 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6768 we construct an input_event. */
6769 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
)
6771 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event
, &inev
.ie
);
6772 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
6775 else if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
)
6777 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event
, &inev
.ie
);
6778 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
6781 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6783 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6784 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
6786 enum xembed_message msg
= event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
6787 if (msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
|| msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
)
6788 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
6790 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
6794 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, event
);
6799 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f
, &event
->xclient
, dpyinfo
, &inev
.ie
))
6800 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6804 case SelectionNotify
:
6805 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xselection
.time
);
6806 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6807 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xselection
.requestor
))
6809 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6810 x_handle_selection_notify (&event
->xselection
);
6813 case SelectionClear
: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6814 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xselectionclear
.time
);
6815 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6816 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xselectionclear
.window
))
6818 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6820 const XSelectionClearEvent
*eventp
= &event
->xselectionclear
;
6822 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT
;
6823 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev
.sie
) = dpyinfo
;
6824 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6825 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6829 case SelectionRequest
: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6830 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xselectionrequest
.time
);
6831 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6832 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xselectionrequest
.owner
))
6834 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6836 const XSelectionRequestEvent
*eventp
= &event
->xselectionrequest
;
6838 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT
;
6839 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev
.sie
) = dpyinfo
;
6840 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->requestor
;
6841 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6842 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->target
;
6843 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->property
;
6844 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6848 case PropertyNotify
:
6849 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xproperty
.time
);
6850 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xproperty
.window
);
6851 if (f
&& event
->xproperty
.atom
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
)
6853 int not_hidden
= x_handle_net_wm_state (f
, &event
->xproperty
);
6854 if (not_hidden
&& FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6856 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6857 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6858 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6859 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
6860 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 0);
6861 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6862 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
6863 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6865 else if (! not_hidden
&& ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6867 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
6868 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
6869 inev
.ie
.kind
= ICONIFY_EVENT
;
6870 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6874 x_handle_property_notify (&event
->xproperty
);
6875 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, event
);
6878 case ReparentNotify
:
6879 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xreparent
.window
);
6882 f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
= event
->xreparent
.parent
;
6883 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
6885 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6886 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
6887 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->net_supported_window
= 0;
6889 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
6894 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xexpose
.window
);
6897 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
6899 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
6900 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 0);
6901 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6902 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6907 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6 and later, see
6908 http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=15398. */
6909 x_clear_area (event
->xexpose
.display
,
6910 event
->xexpose
.window
,
6911 event
->xexpose
.x
, event
->xexpose
.y
,
6912 event
->xexpose
.width
, event
->xexpose
.height
);
6914 expose_frame (f
, event
->xexpose
.x
, event
->xexpose
.y
,
6915 event
->xexpose
.width
, event
->xexpose
.height
);
6920 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6921 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
6923 #if defined USE_LUCID
6924 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6925 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6926 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6928 Widget widget
= x_window_to_menu_bar (event
->xexpose
.window
);
6930 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget
);
6932 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6934 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6935 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6937 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6938 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
->xexpose
.display
,
6939 event
->xexpose
.window
, 2);
6942 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar
, event
);
6943 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6946 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6947 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6951 case GraphicsExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6952 source area was obscured or not
6954 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xgraphicsexpose
.drawable
);
6956 expose_frame (f
, event
->xgraphicsexpose
.x
,
6957 event
->xgraphicsexpose
.y
,
6958 event
->xgraphicsexpose
.width
,
6959 event
->xgraphicsexpose
.height
);
6960 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6963 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6966 case NoExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6967 source area was completely
6972 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6973 if (event
->xunmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6976 x_redo_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo
);
6979 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xunmap
.window
);
6980 if (f
) /* F may no longer exist if
6981 the frame was deleted. */
6983 bool visible
= FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
);
6984 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6985 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6986 display that won't ever be seen. */
6987 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
6988 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6989 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6990 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6991 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6992 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6993 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6994 if (visible
|| FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6996 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
6997 inev
.ie
.kind
= ICONIFY_EVENT
;
6998 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
7004 if (event
->xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
7005 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
7006 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
7009 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
7010 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
7011 frame is visible. */
7012 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xmap
.window
);
7015 bool iconified
= FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
);
7017 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
7018 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
7019 if (!f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
)
7020 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
7022 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
7023 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 0);
7024 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
7028 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
7029 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
7031 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list
) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
7032 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
7033 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
7034 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
7037 xg_frame_resized (f
, -1, -1);
7044 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xkey
.time
);
7045 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
7047 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7048 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
7049 if (popup_activated ())
7055 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7056 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
7057 mouse highlighting. */
7058 if (!hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
&& INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight
)
7060 || !EQ (f
->tool_bar_window
, hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
)))
7062 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
7063 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 1;
7067 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7070 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
7071 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
7072 Widget widget
= XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo
->display
,
7073 event
->xkey
.window
);
7074 if (widget
&& XmIsScrollBar (widget
))
7076 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
7077 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, XtWindow (widget
));
7080 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7084 KeySym keysym
, orig_keysym
;
7085 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
7086 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
7089 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
7090 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
7091 status_return even if the input is too long to
7092 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
7093 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
7094 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
7095 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
7096 unsigned char copy_buffer
[513];
7097 unsigned char *copy_bufptr
= copy_buffer
;
7098 int copy_bufsiz
= sizeof (copy_buffer
);
7100 Lisp_Object coding_system
= Qlatin_1
;
7102 /* Event will be modified. */
7103 XKeyEvent xkey
= event
->xkey
;
7106 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
7107 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
7108 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is nonzero
7110 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
7113 xkey
.state
|= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
7114 extra_keyboard_modifiers
);
7115 modifiers
= xkey
.state
;
7117 /* This will have to go some day... */
7119 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
7120 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
7121 xkey
.state
&= ~ControlMask
;
7122 xkey
.state
&= ~(dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
7123 | dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
7124 | dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
7125 | dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
);
7127 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
7128 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
7129 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
7130 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
7131 not it is combined with Meta. */
7132 if (modifiers
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
7133 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
7138 Status status_return
;
7140 coding_system
= Vlocale_coding_system
;
7141 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
7142 &xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
7143 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
7145 if (status_return
== XBufferOverflow
)
7147 copy_bufsiz
= nbytes
+ 1;
7148 copy_bufptr
= alloca (copy_bufsiz
);
7149 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
7150 &xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
7151 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
7154 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
7155 if (status_return
== XLookupNone
)
7157 else if (status_return
== XLookupChars
)
7162 else if (status_return
!= XLookupKeySym
7163 && status_return
!= XLookupBoth
)
7167 nbytes
= XLookupString (&xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
7168 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
7171 nbytes
= XLookupString (&xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
7172 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
7176 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
7177 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
7178 if (compose_status
.chars_matched
> 0 && nbytes
== 0)
7181 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
7182 orig_keysym
= keysym
;
7184 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
7185 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
7187 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
), modifiers
);
7188 inev
.ie
.timestamp
= xkey
.time
;
7190 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
7191 translations to characters. */
7192 if (keysym
>= 32 && keysym
< 128)
7193 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
7195 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
7196 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
7200 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
7201 if (keysym
>= 0x01000000 && keysym
<= 0x0110FFFF)
7203 if (keysym
< 0x01000080)
7204 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
7206 inev
.ie
.kind
= MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
7207 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
& 0xFFFFFF;
7211 /* Now non-ASCII. */
7212 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table
)
7213 && (c
= Fgethash (make_number (keysym
),
7218 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c
))
7219 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
7220 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
7221 inev
.ie
.code
= XFASTINT (c
);
7225 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
7226 if (((keysym
>= XK_BackSpace
&& keysym
<= XK_Escape
)
7227 || keysym
== XK_Delete
7228 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
7229 || (keysym
>= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
7230 && keysym
<= XK_ISO_Enter
)
7232 || IsCursorKey (keysym
) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
7233 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
7235 /* This recognizes the "extended function
7236 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
7237 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
7238 mode_switch incorrectly. */
7239 || (XK_Select
<= keysym
&& keysym
< XK_KP_Space
)
7241 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
7242 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_circumflex
7244 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
7245 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_grave
7247 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
7248 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_tilde
7250 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
7251 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_diaeresis
7253 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
7254 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_macron
7256 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
7257 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_degree
7259 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
7260 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_acute
7262 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
7263 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_cedilla
7265 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
7266 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_breve
7268 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
7269 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_ogonek
7271 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
7272 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_caron
7274 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
7275 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_doubleacute
7277 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
7278 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_abovedot
7280 || IsKeypadKey (keysym
) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
7281 || IsFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
7282 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
7283 || (orig_keysym
& (1 << 28))
7284 || (keysym
!= NoSymbol
&& nbytes
== 0))
7285 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym
)
7286 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
7287 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
7288 don't have real modifiers but
7289 should be treated similarly to
7290 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
7291 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
7292 || (XK_ISO_Lock
<= orig_keysym
7293 && orig_keysym
<= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
)
7297 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym
);
7298 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
7300 inev
.ie
.kind
= NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
7301 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
7305 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
7309 for (i
= 0, nchars
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
++)
7311 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (copy_bufptr
[i
]))
7313 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr
[i
]);
7316 if (nchars
< nbytes
)
7318 /* Decode the input data. */
7320 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
7321 which depends on which X*LookupString function
7322 we used just above and the locale. */
7323 setup_coding_system (coding_system
, &coding
);
7324 coding
.src_multibyte
= 0;
7325 coding
.dst_multibyte
= 1;
7326 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
7327 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
7328 gives us composition information. */
7329 coding
.common_flags
&= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK
;
7331 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding
.destination
, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH
,
7333 coding
.dst_bytes
= MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH
* nbytes
;
7334 coding
.mode
|= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK
;
7335 decode_coding_c_string (&coding
, copy_bufptr
, nbytes
, Qnil
);
7336 nbytes
= coding
.produced
;
7337 nchars
= coding
.produced_char
;
7338 copy_bufptr
= coding
.destination
;
7341 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
7342 character events. */
7343 for (i
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
+= len
)
7346 if (nchars
== nbytes
)
7347 ch
= copy_bufptr
[i
], len
= 1;
7349 ch
= STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr
+ i
, len
);
7350 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch
)
7351 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
7352 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
7354 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
7359 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
; /* Already stored above. */
7361 if (keysym
== NoSymbol
)
7364 /* FIXME: check side effects and remove this. */
7365 ((XEvent
*) event
)->xkey
= xkey
;
7369 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
7370 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
7378 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xkey
.time
);
7380 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
7381 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
7389 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xcrossing
.time
);
7390 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7394 if (f
&& x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
)
7395 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= event
->xmotion
.time
+ 200;
7397 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
7398 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
7399 if (f
&& !f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_p
)
7400 note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
->xmotion
);
7402 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
7403 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
7404 if (!f
&& dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
7405 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
->xmotion
);
7410 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7414 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xcrossing
.time
);
7415 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7417 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xcrossing
.window
);
7420 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
7422 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
7423 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
7424 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
7425 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
7428 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
7429 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
7430 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
7431 the mouse leaves the frame. */
7432 if (any_help_event_p
)
7436 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
7437 else if (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
7438 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
->xmotion
);
7443 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7448 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xmotion
.time
);
7449 previous_help_echo_string
= help_echo_string
;
7450 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
7452 f
= (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo
) ? dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
7453 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xmotion
.window
));
7455 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
)
7457 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 0;
7458 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
7462 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, event
))
7468 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
7469 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
7470 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window
) && !popup_activated ())
7472 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_window
;
7473 Lisp_Object window
= window_from_coordinates
7474 (f
, event
->xmotion
.x
, event
->xmotion
.y
, 0, 0);
7476 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
7477 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
7478 will be selected only when it is active. */
7479 if (WINDOWP (window
)
7480 && !EQ (window
, last_mouse_window
)
7481 && !EQ (window
, selected_window
)
7482 /* For click-to-focus window managers
7483 create event iff we don't leave the
7485 && (focus_follows_mouse
7486 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window
)->frame
,
7487 XWINDOW (selected_window
)->frame
))))
7489 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT
;
7490 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= window
;
7492 /* Remember the last window where we saw the mouse. */
7493 last_mouse_window
= window
;
7495 if (!note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
->xmotion
))
7496 help_echo_string
= previous_help_echo_string
;
7500 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7501 struct scroll_bar
*bar
7502 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
->xmotion
.display
,
7503 event
->xmotion
.window
, 2);
7506 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar
, &event
->xmotion
);
7507 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7509 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
7510 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
7511 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
7514 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
7515 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
7516 if (!NILP (help_echo_string
)
7517 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string
))
7522 case ConfigureNotify
:
7523 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xconfigure
.window
);
7527 && event
->xconfigure
.window
== FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
7529 xg_frame_resized (f
, event
->xconfigure
.width
,
7530 event
->xconfigure
.height
);
7536 x_net_wm_state (f
, event
->xconfigure
.window
);
7538 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7540 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f
, event
->xconfigure
.width
);
7541 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f
, event
->xconfigure
.height
);
7543 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
7544 is called by the code that handles resizing
7545 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
7547 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
7548 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
7549 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
7550 if (width
!= FRAME_TEXT_WIDTH (f
)
7551 || height
!= FRAME_TEXT_HEIGHT (f
)
7552 || event
->xconfigure
.width
!= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
7553 || event
->xconfigure
.height
!= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
))
7555 change_frame_size (f
, width
, height
, 0, 1, 0, 1);
7556 x_clear_under_internal_border (f
);
7557 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
7558 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
7560 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7564 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
7565 Only get real positions when mapped. */
7566 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)
7567 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)))
7569 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
7572 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
))
7573 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
7582 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
7583 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
7584 bool tool_bar_p
= 0;
7586 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
7587 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
= NULL
;
7588 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xbutton
.time
);
7590 f
= (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo
) ? dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
7591 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xbutton
.window
));
7594 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, event
))
7599 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7600 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
7601 if (WINDOWP (f
->tool_bar_window
)
7602 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f
->tool_bar_window
)))
7605 int x
= event
->xbutton
.x
;
7606 int y
= event
->xbutton
.y
;
7608 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
, x
, y
, 0, 1);
7609 tool_bar_p
= EQ (window
, f
->tool_bar_window
);
7611 if (tool_bar_p
&& event
->xbutton
.button
< 4)
7612 handle_tool_bar_click
7613 (f
, x
, y
, event
->xbutton
.type
== ButtonPress
,
7614 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo
, event
->xbutton
.state
));
7616 #endif /* !USE_GTK */
7619 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7620 if (! popup_activated ())
7623 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
)
7625 if (event
->type
== ButtonPress
7626 && event
->xbutton
.time
> ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
)
7628 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
7629 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
->xbutton
, f
);
7631 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
)
7632 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
7635 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
->xbutton
, f
);
7637 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
7638 xembed_send_message (f
, event
->xbutton
.time
,
7639 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
, 0, 0, 0);
7643 struct scroll_bar
*bar
7644 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
->xbutton
.display
,
7645 event
->xbutton
.window
, 2);
7647 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7648 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
7650 if (bar
&& event
->xbutton
.state
& ControlMask
)
7652 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7653 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
7655 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7657 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7658 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7661 if (event
->type
== ButtonPress
)
7663 dpyinfo
->grabbed
|= (1 << event
->xbutton
.button
);
7664 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
= f
;
7665 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7666 if (f
&& !tool_bar_p
)
7667 f
->last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
7668 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7671 dpyinfo
->grabbed
&= ~(1 << event
->xbutton
.button
);
7673 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
7674 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
7675 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
7679 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7680 f
= x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
);
7681 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
7682 don't pass it to Xt right now.
7683 Instead, save it away
7684 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
7685 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
7686 if (! popup_activated ()
7688 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
7689 && event
->xbutton
.button
< 3
7691 && f
&& event
->type
== ButtonPress
7692 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7693 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7694 && event
->xbutton
.x
>= 0
7695 && event
->xbutton
.x
< FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
7696 && event
->xbutton
.y
>= 0
7697 && event
->xbutton
.y
< FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
)
7698 && event
->xbutton
.same_screen
)
7700 if (!f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
)
7701 f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
= xmalloc (sizeof *event
);
7702 *f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
= *event
;
7703 inev
.ie
.kind
= MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT
;
7704 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
7705 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
7709 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7713 case CirculateNotify
:
7716 case CirculateRequest
:
7719 case VisibilityNotify
:
7723 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7725 switch (event
->xmapping
.request
)
7727 case MappingModifier
:
7728 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
7729 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7730 case MappingKeyboard
:
7731 XRefreshKeyboardMapping ((XMappingEvent
*) &event
->xmapping
);
7736 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, event
);
7741 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7743 if (*finish
!= X_EVENT_DROP
)
7744 XtDispatchEvent ((XEvent
*) event
);
7746 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7751 if (inev
.ie
.kind
!= NO_EVENT
)
7753 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
7758 && !(hold_quit
&& hold_quit
->kind
!= NO_EVENT
))
7763 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
7769 any_help_event_p
= 1;
7770 gen_help_event (help_echo_string
, frame
, help_echo_window
,
7771 help_echo_object
, help_echo_pos
);
7775 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
7776 gen_help_event (Qnil
, frame
, Qnil
, Qnil
, 0);
7785 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7786 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7787 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7789 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7791 x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*event
, Display
*display
)
7793 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
7794 int finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
7796 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (display
);
7799 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, event
, &finish
, 0);
7804 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7805 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7807 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7808 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7809 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7813 XTread_socket (struct terminal
*terminal
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
7816 int event_found
= 0;
7817 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= terminal
->display_info
.x
;
7821 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7822 if (dpyinfo
== XTread_socket_fake_io_error
)
7824 XTread_socket_fake_io_error
= 0;
7825 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo
->display
);
7829 while (XPending (dpyinfo
->display
))
7834 XNextEvent (dpyinfo
->display
, &event
);
7837 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7838 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, &event
))
7843 count
+= handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, &event
, &finish
, hold_quit
);
7845 if (finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7851 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7852 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7853 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7854 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7856 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7857 from all displays. */
7859 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7861 current_count
= count
;
7862 current_hold_quit
= hold_quit
;
7864 gtk_main_iteration ();
7866 count
= current_count
;
7868 current_hold_quit
= 0;
7870 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7873 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7875 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7876 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7879 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7880 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7881 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7883 if (x_noop_count
>= 100)
7887 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== 0)
7888 next_noop_dpyinfo
= x_display_list
;
7890 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo
->display
);
7892 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7893 next_noop_dpyinfo
= next_noop_dpyinfo
->next
;
7897 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7898 raise it now. FIXME: handle more than one such frame. */
7899 if (dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
)
7901 x_raise_frame (dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
);
7902 dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
= NULL
;
7913 /***********************************************************************
7915 ***********************************************************************/
7917 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7918 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7920 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7921 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7922 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7925 x_clip_to_row (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
,
7926 enum glyph_row_area area
, GC gc
)
7928 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7929 XRectangle clip_rect
;
7930 int window_x
, window_y
, window_width
;
7932 window_box (w
, area
, &window_x
, &window_y
, &window_width
, 0);
7934 clip_rect
.x
= window_x
;
7935 clip_rect
.y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, row
->y
));
7936 clip_rect
.y
= max (clip_rect
.y
, window_y
);
7937 clip_rect
.width
= window_width
;
7938 clip_rect
.height
= row
->visible_height
;
7940 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
, 0, 0, &clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
7944 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7947 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
)
7949 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7950 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
7951 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7954 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7957 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7958 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7959 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7960 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7963 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7964 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &x
, &y
, &h
);
7965 wd
= w
->phys_cursor_width
- 1;
7967 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7968 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7969 xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7970 if (dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
)
7971 XChangeGC (dpy
, dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7973 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7974 GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7975 gc
= dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7977 /* When on R2L character, show cursor at the right edge of the
7978 glyph, unless the cursor box is as wide as the glyph or wider
7979 (the latter happens when x-stretch-cursor is non-nil). */
7980 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0
7981 && cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
> wd
)
7983 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- wd
;
7987 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7988 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7989 XDrawRectangle (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
, x
, y
, wd
, h
- 1);
7990 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7994 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7996 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7997 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7998 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
8002 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, int width
, enum text_cursor_kinds kind
)
8004 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
8005 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
8007 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
8008 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
8010 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
8011 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
8014 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
8015 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
8016 the bar might not be in the window. */
8017 if (cursor_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
)
8019 struct glyph_row
*r
;
8020 r
= MATRIX_ROW (w
->current_matrix
, w
->phys_cursor
.vpos
);
8021 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, r
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
8025 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8026 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
8027 GC gc
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
8028 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
8029 struct face
*face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, cursor_glyph
->face_id
);
8032 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
8033 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
8034 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
8035 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
8036 that the glyph is legible. */
8037 if (face
->background
== f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
8038 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= face
->foreground
;
8040 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
8041 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= 0;
8044 XChangeGC (dpy
, gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
8047 gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
8048 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
= gc
;
8051 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
8053 if (kind
== BAR_CURSOR
)
8055 int x
= WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
);
8058 width
= FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f
);
8059 width
= min (cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
, width
);
8061 w
->phys_cursor_width
= width
;
8063 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
8064 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
8065 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0)
8066 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- width
;
8068 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
, x
,
8069 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
),
8070 width
, row
->height
);
8072 else /* HBAR_CURSOR */
8074 int dummy_x
, dummy_y
, dummy_h
;
8075 int x
= WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
);
8078 width
= row
->height
;
8080 width
= min (row
->height
, width
);
8082 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &dummy_x
,
8083 &dummy_y
, &dummy_h
);
8085 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0
8086 && cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
> w
->phys_cursor_width
- 1)
8087 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- w
->phys_cursor_width
+ 1;
8088 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
, x
,
8089 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
+
8090 row
->height
- width
),
8091 w
->phys_cursor_width
- 1, width
);
8094 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
8099 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
8102 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame
*f
, Cursor cursor
)
8104 if (!f
->pointer_invisible
8105 && f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
!= cursor
)
8106 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), cursor
);
8107 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
= cursor
;
8111 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
8114 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
)
8116 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), x
, y
, width
, height
);
8118 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
8119 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
8120 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
8125 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
8128 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*glyph_row
, int x
,
8129 int y
, enum text_cursor_kinds cursor_type
,
8130 int cursor_width
, bool on_p
, bool active_p
)
8132 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
8136 w
->phys_cursor_type
= cursor_type
;
8137 w
->phys_cursor_on_p
= 1;
8139 if (glyph_row
->exact_window_width_line_p
8140 && (glyph_row
->reversed_p
8141 ? (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
< 0)
8142 : (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
>= glyph_row
->used
[TEXT_AREA
])))
8144 glyph_row
->cursor_in_fringe_p
= 1;
8145 draw_fringe_bitmap (w
, glyph_row
, glyph_row
->reversed_p
);
8149 switch (cursor_type
)
8151 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR
:
8152 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w
, glyph_row
);
8155 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR
:
8156 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, glyph_row
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
8160 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, BAR_CURSOR
);
8164 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, HBAR_CURSOR
);
8168 w
->phys_cursor_width
= 0;
8177 if (w
== XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
))
8178 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
))
8179 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, x
, y
);
8183 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8189 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
8192 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object file
)
8194 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id
;
8196 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
8199 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
8200 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
8201 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
8202 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
8207 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
8208 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
8209 if (xg_set_icon (f
, file
))
8211 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8212 bitmap_id
= x_create_bitmap_from_file (f
, file
);
8213 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, bitmap_id
);
8217 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
8218 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
< 0)
8224 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
== -2
8225 || xg_set_icon (f
, xg_default_icon_file
)
8226 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
))
8228 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= -2;
8232 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
8234 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
);
8236 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
8240 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
8243 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_data (f
, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits
,
8244 gnu_xbm_width
, gnu_xbm_height
);
8248 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
8249 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
8253 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
8254 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
8255 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
8256 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
8257 x_reference_bitmap (f
, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
8259 bitmap_id
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
;
8262 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, bitmap_id
);
8263 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= bitmap_id
;
8269 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
8270 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
8273 x_text_icon (struct frame
*f
, const char *icon_name
)
8275 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
8280 text
.value
= (unsigned char *) icon_name
;
8281 text
.encoding
= XA_STRING
;
8283 text
.nitems
= strlen (icon_name
);
8284 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &text
);
8287 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
8288 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
8289 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
8290 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, 0);
8295 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
8297 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
8298 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
8300 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
8301 be called from a signal handler.
8304 struct x_error_message_stack
{
8305 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
8307 struct x_error_message_stack
*prev
;
8309 static struct x_error_message_stack
*x_error_message
;
8311 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
8312 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
8313 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
8316 x_error_catcher (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
8318 XGetErrorText (display
, event
->error_code
,
8319 x_error_message
->string
,
8320 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
8323 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
8324 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
8327 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
8328 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
8329 stored in *x_error_message.
8331 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
8332 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
8334 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
8337 x_catch_errors (Display
*dpy
)
8339 struct x_error_message_stack
*data
= xmalloc (sizeof *data
);
8341 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
8345 data
->string
[0] = 0;
8346 data
->prev
= x_error_message
;
8347 x_error_message
= data
;
8350 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
8351 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
8354 x_uncatch_errors (void)
8356 struct x_error_message_stack
*tmp
;
8360 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
8361 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
8362 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message
->dpy
) != 0)
8363 XSync (x_error_message
->dpy
, False
);
8365 tmp
= x_error_message
;
8366 x_error_message
= x_error_message
->prev
;
8371 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
8372 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
8373 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
8376 x_check_errors (Display
*dpy
, const char *format
)
8378 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8381 if (x_error_message
->string
[0])
8383 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
8384 memcpy (string
, x_error_message
->string
, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
8385 x_uncatch_errors ();
8386 error (format
, string
);
8390 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
8391 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8394 x_had_errors_p (Display
*dpy
)
8396 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8399 return x_error_message
->string
[0] != 0;
8402 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8405 x_clear_errors (Display
*dpy
)
8407 x_error_message
->string
[0] = 0;
8410 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
8411 * idea. --lorentey */
8412 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
8415 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
8417 while (x_error_message
)
8418 x_uncatch_errors ();
8423 static unsigned int x_wire_count
;
8426 fprintf (stderr
, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count
);
8431 /************************************************************************
8433 ************************************************************************/
8435 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
8437 static char *error_msg
;
8439 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
8440 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
8443 x_connection_closed (Display
*dpy
, const char *error_message
)
8445 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
8446 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
8447 ptrdiff_t idx
= SPECPDL_INDEX ();
8449 error_msg
= alloca (strlen (error_message
) + 1);
8450 strcpy (error_msg
, error_message
);
8452 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
8453 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay
, Qt
);
8457 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
8459 dpyinfo
->reference_count
++;
8460 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
++;
8463 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
8464 that are on the dead display. */
8465 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8467 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame
;
8469 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame
))));
8470 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
8471 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
))
8472 && ! EQ (frame
, minibuf_frame
)
8473 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
8474 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
8477 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
8478 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
8479 for another frame that we need to delete. */
8480 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8481 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
8482 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
8484 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
8485 trying to find a replacement. */
8486 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame
)), Qt
);
8487 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
8490 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
8491 first place, so don't try to close it. */
8494 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
8495 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
8496 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
8498 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
8499 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
8500 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
8501 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
8502 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil
);
8503 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n\
8504 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
8505 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
8506 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
8509 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8511 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
8512 dpyinfo
->display
= 0;
8514 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
8515 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
--;
8516 if (dpyinfo
->reference_count
!= 0)
8517 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
8522 XSETTERMINAL (tmp
, dpyinfo
->terminal
);
8523 Fdelete_terminal (tmp
, Qnoelisp
);
8527 if (terminal_list
== 0)
8529 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n", error_msg
);
8530 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
8534 totally_unblock_input ();
8536 unbind_to (idx
, Qnil
);
8537 clear_waiting_for_input ();
8539 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
8540 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list
) return; )
8542 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
8543 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
8544 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
8545 error ("%s", error_msg
);
8548 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
8549 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
8550 static void x_error_quitter (Display
*, XErrorEvent
*);
8552 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
8553 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
8556 x_error_handler (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
8558 #if defined USE_GTK && defined HAVE_GTK3
8559 if ((event
->error_code
== BadMatch
|| event
->error_code
== BadWindow
)
8560 && event
->request_code
== X_SetInputFocus
)
8566 if (x_error_message
)
8567 x_error_catcher (display
, event
);
8569 x_error_quitter (display
, event
);
8573 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
8574 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
8575 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8577 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
8579 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
8580 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
8582 static void NO_INLINE
8583 x_error_quitter (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
8585 char buf
[256], buf1
[356];
8587 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
8588 or colors that are not defined. */
8590 if (event
->error_code
== BadName
)
8593 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
8594 original error handler. */
8596 XGetErrorText (display
, event
->error_code
, buf
, sizeof (buf
));
8597 sprintf (buf1
, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
8598 buf
, event
->request_code
);
8599 x_connection_closed (display
, buf1
);
8603 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
8604 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
8605 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8608 x_io_error_quitter (Display
*display
)
8612 snprintf (buf
, sizeof buf
, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
8613 DisplayString (display
));
8614 x_connection_closed (display
, buf
);
8618 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
8620 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
8621 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
8622 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
8626 x_new_font (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object font_object
, int fontset
)
8628 struct font
*font
= XFONT_OBJECT (font_object
);
8632 fontset
= fontset_from_font (font_object
);
8633 FRAME_FONTSET (f
) = fontset
;
8634 if (FRAME_FONT (f
) == font
)
8635 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8639 FRAME_FONT (f
) = font
;
8640 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f
) = font
->baseline_offset
;
8641 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) = font
->average_width
;
8642 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) = FONT_HEIGHT (font
);
8644 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8645 FRAME_MENU_BAR_HEIGHT (f
) = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f
) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
8648 /* Compute character columns occupied by scrollbar.
8650 Don't do things differently for non-toolkit scrollbars
8652 unit
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
8653 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) > 0)
8654 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
)
8655 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) + unit
- 1) / unit
;
8657 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) = (14 + unit
- 1) / unit
;
8659 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) != 0)
8661 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8662 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8663 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8664 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
8665 x_set_window_size (f
, 0, FRAME_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
),
8666 FRAME_LINES (f
) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
), 1);
8671 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & (XIMPreeditPosition
| XIMStatusArea
)))
8674 xic_set_xfontset (f
, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset
)));
8683 /***********************************************************************
8685 ***********************************************************************/
8691 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8692 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8693 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8696 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
8698 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) client_data
;
8699 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
8703 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8704 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8706 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
8707 if (FRAME_X_P (f
) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
)
8709 FRAME_XIC (f
) = NULL
;
8710 xic_free_xfontset (f
);
8714 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8715 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8716 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8720 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8722 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8723 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8726 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
8734 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8735 xim
= XOpenIM (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, resource_name
,
8742 XIMCallback destroy
;
8745 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8746 XGetIMValues (xim
, XNQueryInputStyle
, &dpyinfo
->xim_styles
, NULL
);
8749 destroy
.callback
= xim_destroy_callback
;
8750 destroy
.client_data
= (XPointer
)dpyinfo
;
8751 XSetIMValues (xim
, XNDestroyCallback
, &destroy
, NULL
);
8757 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8758 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8762 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8764 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8765 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8766 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8767 when the callback was registered. */
8770 xim_instantiate_callback (Display
*display
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
8772 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) client_data
;
8773 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= xim_inst
->dpyinfo
;
8775 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8779 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, xim_inst
->resource_name
);
8781 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8782 as they have no XIC. */
8783 if (dpyinfo
->xim
&& dpyinfo
->reference_count
> 0)
8785 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
8788 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8790 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
8793 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == xim_inst
->dpyinfo
)
8794 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) == NULL
)
8796 create_frame_xic (f
);
8797 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
)
8798 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
8799 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
)
8801 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
);
8802 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, w
->cursor
.x
, w
->cursor
.y
);
8811 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8814 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8815 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8816 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8817 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8820 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
8822 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8826 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8827 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst
);
8830 dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
= xim_inst
;
8831 xim_inst
->dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
;
8832 xim_inst
->resource_name
= xstrdup (resource_name
);
8833 ret
= XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback
8834 (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, xim_inst
->resource_name
,
8835 emacs_class
, xim_instantiate_callback
,
8836 /* This is XPointer in XFree86 but (XPointer *)
8837 on Tru64, at least, hence the configure test. */
8838 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6
) xim_inst
);
8839 eassert (ret
== True
);
8840 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8841 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
8842 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8844 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8848 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8851 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
8856 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8857 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
;
8859 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8861 Bool ret
= XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback
8862 (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, xim_inst
->resource_name
,
8863 emacs_class
, xim_instantiate_callback
,
8864 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6
) xim_inst
);
8865 eassert (ret
== True
);
8867 xfree (xim_inst
->resource_name
);
8869 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8870 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8871 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8872 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8873 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8875 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8878 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8882 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8883 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8886 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame
*f
)
8888 int flags
= f
->size_hint_flags
;
8890 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8891 is already for the top-left corner. */
8892 if (! ((flags
& XNegative
) || (flags
& YNegative
)))
8895 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8896 position that fits on the screen. */
8897 if (flags
& XNegative
)
8898 f
->left_pos
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8899 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) + f
->left_pos
;
8902 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8904 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8905 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8906 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8908 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8909 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8910 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8911 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8914 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8915 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8917 XtVaGetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->column_widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
8920 if (flags
& YNegative
)
8921 f
->top_pos
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8922 - height
+ f
->top_pos
;
8925 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8926 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8927 so the flags should correspond. */
8928 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8931 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8932 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8933 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8934 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8935 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8938 x_set_offset (struct frame
*f
, register int xoff
, register int yoff
, int change_gravity
)
8940 int modified_top
, modified_left
;
8942 if (change_gravity
> 0)
8946 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8948 f
->size_hint_flags
|= XNegative
;
8950 f
->size_hint_flags
|= YNegative
;
8951 f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8953 x_calc_absolute_position (f
);
8956 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, 0, 0);
8958 modified_left
= f
->left_pos
;
8959 modified_top
= f
->top_pos
;
8961 if (change_gravity
!= 0 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
)
8963 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8964 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8965 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8966 modified_left
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8967 modified_top
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8970 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8971 modified_left
, modified_top
);
8973 x_sync_with_move (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
,
8974 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8977 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8978 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8979 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8980 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8983 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8984 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8985 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8987 if (change_gravity
!= 0 &&
8988 (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8989 || (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
8990 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
== 0
8991 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
== 0))))
8992 x_check_expected_move (f
, modified_left
, modified_top
);
8997 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8998 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8999 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
9000 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9001 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
9004 wm_supports (struct frame
*f
, Atom want_atom
)
9007 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
9008 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
9009 Window wmcheck_window
;
9010 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9011 Window target_window
= dpyinfo
->root_window
;
9012 long max_len
= 65536;
9013 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
9014 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
9015 Atom target_type
= XA_WINDOW
;
9019 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
9020 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
9021 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
,
9022 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
9023 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
9024 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
9026 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_WINDOW
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9028 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
9029 x_uncatch_errors ();
9034 wmcheck_window
= *(Window
*) tmp_data
;
9037 /* Check if window exists. */
9038 XSelectInput (dpy
, wmcheck_window
, StructureNotifyMask
);
9040 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9042 x_uncatch_errors ();
9047 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
!= wmcheck_window
)
9049 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
9050 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
!= NULL
)
9051 XFree (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
);
9052 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
9053 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
9054 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
9056 target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
9058 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
9059 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supported
,
9060 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
9061 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
9062 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
9064 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_ATOM
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9066 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
9067 x_uncatch_errors ();
9072 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= (Atom
*)tmp_data
;
9073 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= actual_size
;
9074 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= wmcheck_window
;
9079 for (i
= 0; rc
== 0 && i
< dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
; ++i
)
9080 rc
= dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
[i
] == want_atom
;
9082 x_uncatch_errors ();
9089 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame
, int add
, Atom atom
, Atom value
)
9091 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
));
9093 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
9094 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
9096 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
9098 (make_number (add
? 1 : 0),
9100 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom
),
9102 ? list1 (make_fixnum_or_float (value
))
9107 x_set_sticky (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object new_value
, Lisp_Object old_value
)
9110 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9112 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9114 set_wm_state (frame
, NILP (new_value
) ? 0 : 1,
9115 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
, None
);
9118 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
9119 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
9120 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
9122 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
9125 get_current_wm_state (struct frame
*f
,
9131 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
9132 int i
, rc
, actual_format
, is_hidden
= 0;
9133 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9134 long max_len
= 65536;
9135 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
9136 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
9137 Atom target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
9140 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
9143 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
9144 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, window
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
9145 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
9146 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
9147 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
9149 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= target_type
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9151 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
9152 x_uncatch_errors ();
9154 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
);
9157 x_uncatch_errors ();
9159 for (i
= 0; i
< actual_size
; ++i
)
9161 Atom a
= ((Atom
*)tmp_data
)[i
];
9162 if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden
)
9166 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
)
9168 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
9169 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
9171 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
;
9173 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
)
9175 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
)
9176 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
9178 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
;
9180 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
)
9181 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_BOTH
;
9182 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
)
9186 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
9191 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
9194 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
9196 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9197 int have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
);
9200 (void)get_current_wm_state (f
, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &cur
, &dummy
);
9202 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
9203 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
9205 have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
);
9207 if (have_net_atom
&& cur
!= f
->want_fullscreen
)
9211 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9213 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
9214 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
9215 are sent at once. */
9216 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
9218 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
9219 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
9220 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
9221 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
9222 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
9223 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
9225 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
9226 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
9227 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
9228 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
9229 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
9230 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
9231 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
, None
);
9233 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
9234 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
9235 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
9236 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
9237 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
);
9238 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
9239 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
, None
);
9241 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
9242 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
9243 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
9244 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
9245 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
9247 case FULLSCREEN_NONE
:
9248 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
9249 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
9251 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
9252 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
9255 f
->want_fullscreen
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
9259 return have_net_atom
;
9263 XTfullscreen_hook (struct frame
*f
)
9265 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9268 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
9276 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*f
, const XPropertyEvent
*event
)
9278 int value
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
9281 int not_hidden
= get_current_wm_state (f
, event
->window
, &value
, &sticky
);
9286 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
9289 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
9292 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
9295 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
9300 store_frame_param (f
, Qfullscreen
, lval
);
9301 store_frame_param (f
, Qsticky
, sticky
? Qt
: Qnil
);
9306 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
9307 If so needed, resize the frame. */
9309 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
9311 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f
))
9314 if (f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
!= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
9315 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
9317 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
9318 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
9319 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
9321 if (f
->want_fullscreen
!= FULLSCREEN_NONE
)
9323 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
), height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
9324 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9326 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
9328 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
9329 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
9330 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
9331 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
9332 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
9334 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
9335 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
9337 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
9338 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
9341 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9346 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
9347 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
9348 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
9349 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
9350 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
9351 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
9352 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
9355 x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*f
, int expected_left
, int expected_top
)
9357 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
9359 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
9360 window manager window around the frame. */
9362 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
9364 if (current_left
!= expected_left
|| current_top
!= expected_top
)
9366 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
9371 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_A
;
9372 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
= expected_left
- current_left
;
9373 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
= expected_top
- current_top
;
9375 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
9377 adjusted_left
= expected_left
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
9378 adjusted_top
= expected_top
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
9380 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9381 adjusted_left
, adjusted_top
);
9383 x_sync_with_move (f
, expected_left
, expected_top
, 0);
9386 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
9387 frame's position. */
9389 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_B
;
9393 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
9394 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
9395 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
9396 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
9397 of an exact comparison. */
9400 x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*f
, int left
, int top
, int fuzzy
)
9404 while (count
++ < 50)
9406 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
9408 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
9409 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
9412 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
9413 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
9417 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
9420 if (eabs (current_left
- left
) <= 10
9421 && eabs (current_top
- top
) <= 40)
9424 else if (current_left
== left
&& current_top
== top
)
9428 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
9429 will then return up-to-date position info. */
9431 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000000, 0, 0, Qnil
, NULL
, 0);
9435 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
9437 x_wait_for_event (struct frame
*f
, int eventtype
)
9439 int level
= interrupt_input_blocked
;
9442 struct timespec tmo
, tmo_at
, time_now
;
9443 int fd
= ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9445 f
->wait_event_type
= eventtype
;
9447 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
9448 Maybe it should be configurable. */
9449 tmo
= make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
9450 tmo_at
= timespec_add (current_timespec (), tmo
);
9452 while (f
->wait_event_type
)
9454 pending_signals
= 1;
9455 totally_unblock_input ();
9456 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
9458 interrupt_input_blocked
= level
;
9463 time_now
= current_timespec ();
9464 if (timespec_cmp (tmo_at
, time_now
) < 0)
9467 tmo
= timespec_sub (tmo_at
, time_now
);
9468 if (pselect (fd
+ 1, &fds
, NULL
, NULL
, &tmo
, NULL
) == 0)
9469 break; /* Timeout */
9472 f
->wait_event_type
= 0;
9476 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to WIDTH/HEIGHT in the case F
9477 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
9478 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
9479 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9482 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*f
, int change_gravity
, int width
, int height
, bool pixelwise
)
9484 int pixelwidth
, pixelheight
;
9486 pixelwidth
= (pixelwise
9487 ? FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, width
)
9488 : FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, width
));
9489 pixelheight
= ((pixelwise
9490 ? FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, height
)
9491 : FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, height
)));
9493 if (change_gravity
) f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
9494 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, 0, 0);
9495 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9496 pixelwidth
, pixelheight
+ FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
));
9499 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
9500 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
9501 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
9502 we have to make sure to do it here. */
9503 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
9505 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
9506 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
9507 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
9508 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
9510 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
9511 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
9512 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
9513 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
9514 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
9516 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
9519 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
9520 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
9521 for the ConfigureNotify. */
9522 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9523 x_wait_for_event (f
, ConfigureNotify
);
9526 change_frame_size (f
, pixelwidth
, pixelheight
, 0, 1, 0, 1);
9532 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
9533 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
9534 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
9535 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9538 x_set_window_size (struct frame
*f
, int change_gravity
, int width
, int height
, bool pixelwise
)
9542 /* The following breaks our calculations. If it's really needed,
9543 think of something else. */
9545 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
9547 int text_width
, text_height
;
9549 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
9550 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
9551 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/width to
9552 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
9553 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
9554 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
9555 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
9556 int pixelh
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
9557 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9558 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
9560 pixelh
-= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
9562 text_width
= FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f
, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
));
9563 text_height
= FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f
, pixelh
);
9565 change_frame_size (f
, text_width
, text_height
, 0, 1, 0, 1);
9570 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
9572 xg_frame_set_char_size (f
, width
* FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
),
9573 height
* FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
));
9575 xg_frame_set_char_size (f
, width
, height
);
9577 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, width
, height
, pixelwise
);
9578 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9580 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, width
, height
, pixelwise
);
9581 x_clear_under_internal_border (f
);
9583 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9585 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
9586 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f
->root_window
));
9588 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
9589 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
9590 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
9591 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
9592 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
9596 do_pending_window_change (0);
9599 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
9602 frame_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame
*f
, int pix_x
, int pix_y
)
9606 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
9607 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
9611 /* Raise frame F. */
9614 x_raise_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9617 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9618 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
9619 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9623 /* Lower frame F. */
9626 x_lower_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9628 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9631 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
9632 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9637 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9640 xembed_request_focus (struct frame
*f
)
9642 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9643 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9644 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9645 xembed_send_message (f
, CurrentTime
,
9646 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
, 0, 0, 0);
9649 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9652 x_ewmh_activate_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9654 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9655 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9657 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9659 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
))
9662 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9663 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
9664 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
,
9666 list2i (1, dpyinfo
->last_user_time
));
9671 XTframe_raise_lower (struct frame
*f
, int raise_flag
)
9679 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9681 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9683 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9685 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9688 xembed_set_info (struct frame
*f
, enum xembed_info flags
)
9690 unsigned long data
[2];
9691 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9693 data
[0] = XEMBED_VERSION
;
9696 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9697 dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
,
9698 32, PropModeReplace
, (unsigned char *) data
, 2);
9700 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9703 xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time t
, enum xembed_message msg
,
9704 long int detail
, long int data1
, long int data2
)
9708 event
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
9709 event
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
;
9710 event
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_XEMBED
;
9711 event
.xclient
.format
= 32;
9712 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = t
;
9713 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1] = msg
;
9714 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[2] = detail
;
9715 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[3] = data1
;
9716 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[4] = data2
;
9718 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
,
9719 False
, NoEventMask
, &event
);
9720 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
9723 /* Change of visibility. */
9725 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9726 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9727 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9728 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9729 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9730 finishes with it. */
9733 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame
*f
)
9735 int original_top
, original_left
;
9740 x_set_bitmap_icon (f
);
9742 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9744 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9745 call x_set_offset a second time
9746 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9747 before the window gets really visible. */
9748 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9749 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9750 && ! f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
)
9751 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9753 f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
= 1;
9755 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9756 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, NormalState
);
9757 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9758 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9759 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
9762 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9763 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9765 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9767 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9768 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9770 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9771 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
9773 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9774 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9775 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9778 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9780 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9781 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9782 so that incoming events are handled. */
9785 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9786 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9787 will set it when they are handled. */
9788 int previously_visible
= f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
;
9790 original_left
= f
->left_pos
;
9791 original_top
= f
->top_pos
;
9793 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9796 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9798 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9799 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9800 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9801 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9803 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9804 because the window manager may choose the position
9805 and we don't want to override it. */
9807 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
9808 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9809 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9810 && f
->win_gravity
== NorthWestGravity
9811 && previously_visible
)
9815 unsigned int width
, height
, border
, depth
;
9819 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9820 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9821 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9822 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9823 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9824 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9825 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9826 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9827 &rootw
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
, &border
, &depth
);
9829 if (original_left
!= x
|| original_top
!= y
)
9830 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9831 original_left
, original_top
);
9836 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9838 /* Process X events until a MapNotify event has been seen. */
9839 while (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9841 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9844 /* If on another desktop, the deiconify/map may be ignored and the
9845 frame never becomes visible. XMonad does this.
9846 Prevent an endless loop. */
9847 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
) && ++tries
> 100)
9850 /* This hack is still in use at least for Cygwin. See
9851 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2013-12/msg00351.html.
9853 Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9854 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9855 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9856 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9857 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9859 if (input_polling_used ())
9861 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9862 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9863 handler reset it. */
9864 int old_poll_suppress_count
= poll_suppress_count
;
9865 poll_suppress_count
= 1;
9866 poll_for_input_1 ();
9867 poll_suppress_count
= old_poll_suppress_count
;
9870 if (XPending (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)))
9873 XNextEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), &xev
);
9874 x_dispatch_event (&xev
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9880 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9882 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9885 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame
*f
)
9889 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9890 window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9892 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9893 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9894 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9898 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9899 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9900 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9901 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9902 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9903 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, 0, 1);
9906 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9907 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9910 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9911 xembed_set_info (f
, 0);
9916 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
,
9917 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))))
9920 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9924 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9925 just by the event that we get from the server.
9926 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9927 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9928 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9929 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9930 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 0);
9937 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9940 x_iconify_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9942 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9946 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9947 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9948 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9950 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
9955 x_set_bitmap_icon (f
);
9957 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9958 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9960 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9961 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9963 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9964 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9965 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
9971 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9973 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9975 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9976 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9977 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9978 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9979 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9980 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9981 so we have to record it here. */
9982 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9983 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
9988 result
= XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9989 XtWindow (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
),
9990 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)));
9994 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9996 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
9997 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
10000 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
10002 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10004 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
10005 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
10006 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
10007 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
10008 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
10009 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
10011 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
10012 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
10014 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
10015 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
10019 msg
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
10020 msg
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
10021 msg
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_wm_change_state
;
10022 msg
.xclient
.format
= 32;
10023 msg
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = IconicState
;
10025 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
10026 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)),
10028 SubstructureRedirectMask
| SubstructureNotifyMask
,
10032 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
10036 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
10038 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
10040 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
10042 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
10043 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10046 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
10047 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
10049 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
10051 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10055 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
10058 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame
*f
)
10060 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
10061 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
10062 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10064 struct scroll_bar
*b
;
10069 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
10070 commands to the X server. */
10071 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
10073 /* Always exit with visible pointer to avoid weird issue
10074 with Xfixes (Bug#17609). */
10075 if (f
->pointer_invisible
)
10076 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->toggle_visible_pointer (f
, 0);
10078 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
10079 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
10081 free_frame_faces (f
);
10083 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
)
10084 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
);
10086 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10087 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
10088 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
10089 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
10090 toolkit scroll bars. */
10091 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); !NILP (bar
); bar
= b
->next
)
10093 b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
10094 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
10100 free_frame_xic (f
);
10103 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10104 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
10106 XtDestroyWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
10107 f
->output_data
.x
->widget
= NULL
;
10109 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
10110 we are using a toolkit. */
10111 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
10112 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10114 free_frame_menubar (f
);
10116 if (f
->shell_position
)
10117 xfree (f
->shell_position
);
10118 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10121 xg_free_frame_widgets (f
);
10122 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10124 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
10125 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10126 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10128 unload_color (f
, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
10129 unload_color (f
, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
10130 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
);
10131 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
);
10132 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
10133 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->mouse_pixel
);
10135 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
!= -1)
10136 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
);
10137 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
10138 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
10139 #if defined (USE_LUCID) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
10140 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
10141 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
10142 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
);
10143 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
10144 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
);
10145 #endif /* USE_LUCID && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10146 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.pixel
!= -1)
10147 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.pixel
);
10148 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.pixel
!= -1)
10149 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.pixel
);
10153 /* Free extra GCs allocated by x_setup_relief_colors. */
10154 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
)
10156 XFreeGC (dpyinfo
->display
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
);
10157 f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
= 0;
10159 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
)
10161 XFreeGC (dpyinfo
->display
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
);
10162 f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
= 0;
10165 /* Free cursors. */
10166 if (f
->output_data
.x
->text_cursor
!= 0)
10167 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->text_cursor
);
10168 if (f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
!= 0)
10169 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
10170 if (f
->output_data
.x
->modeline_cursor
!= 0)
10171 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->modeline_cursor
);
10172 if (f
->output_data
.x
->hand_cursor
!= 0)
10173 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->hand_cursor
);
10174 if (f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_cursor
!= 0)
10175 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_cursor
);
10176 if (f
->output_data
.x
->horizontal_drag_cursor
!= 0)
10177 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->horizontal_drag_cursor
);
10178 if (f
->output_data
.x
->vertical_drag_cursor
!= 0)
10179 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->vertical_drag_cursor
);
10181 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
10184 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
);
10185 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
);
10186 f
->output_data
.x
= NULL
;
10188 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
10189 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
10190 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
)
10191 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
10192 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
10193 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
10194 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
10195 reset_mouse_highlight (hlinfo
);
10201 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
10204 x_destroy_window (struct frame
*f
)
10206 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
10208 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
10209 commands to the X server. */
10210 if (dpyinfo
->display
!= 0)
10211 x_free_frame_resources (f
);
10213 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
10217 /* Setting window manager hints. */
10219 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
10220 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
10221 that the window now has.
10222 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
10223 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
10224 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
10228 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame
*f
, long flags
, bool user_position
)
10230 XSizeHints size_hints
;
10231 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
10236 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10237 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
10239 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
10244 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
10245 size_hints
.flags
= PResizeInc
| PMinSize
/* | PMaxSize */;
10247 size_hints
.x
= f
->left_pos
;
10248 size_hints
.y
= f
->top_pos
;
10250 size_hints
.height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
10251 size_hints
.width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
10253 size_hints
.width_inc
= frame_resize_pixelwise
? 1 : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
10254 size_hints
.height_inc
= frame_resize_pixelwise
? 1 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
10256 size_hints
.max_width
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
10257 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
10258 size_hints
.max_height
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
10259 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
10261 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
10263 int base_width
, base_height
;
10264 int min_rows
= 0, min_cols
= 0;
10266 base_width
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
10267 base_height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
10269 if (frame_resize_pixelwise
)
10270 /* Needed to prevent a bad protocol error crash when making the
10271 frame size very small. */
10273 min_cols
= 2 * min_cols
;
10274 min_rows
= 2 * min_rows
;
10277 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
10278 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
10279 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
10280 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
10281 zero-row, zero-column frame.
10283 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
10284 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
10285 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
10287 size_hints
.flags
|= PBaseSize
;
10288 size_hints
.base_width
= base_width
;
10289 size_hints
.base_height
= base_height
+ FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
10290 size_hints
.min_width
= base_width
+ min_cols
* FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
10291 size_hints
.min_height
= base_height
+ min_rows
* FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
10294 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
10297 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
10302 XSizeHints hints
; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
10303 long supplied_return
;
10306 value
= XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &hints
,
10310 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
10315 if (hints
.flags
& PSize
)
10316 size_hints
.flags
|= PSize
;
10317 if (hints
.flags
& PPosition
)
10318 size_hints
.flags
|= PPosition
;
10319 if (hints
.flags
& USPosition
)
10320 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
10321 if (hints
.flags
& USSize
)
10322 size_hints
.flags
|= USSize
;
10329 size_hints
.win_gravity
= f
->win_gravity
;
10330 size_hints
.flags
|= PWinGravity
;
10334 size_hints
.flags
&= ~ PPosition
;
10335 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
10337 #endif /* PWinGravity */
10339 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &size_hints
);
10341 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
10343 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
10346 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*f
, int state
)
10348 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10351 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNinitialState
, state
);
10352 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
10353 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10354 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
10356 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= StateHint
;
10357 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.initial_state
= state
;
10359 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
10360 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10364 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*f
, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id
)
10366 Pixmap icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
;
10368 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
10369 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
10374 icon_pixmap
= x_bitmap_pixmap (f
, pixmap_id
);
10375 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_pixmap
= icon_pixmap
;
10376 icon_mask
= x_bitmap_mask (f
, pixmap_id
);
10377 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_mask
= icon_mask
;
10381 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
10389 xg_set_frame_icon (f
, icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
);
10393 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
10397 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconPixmap
, icon_pixmap
);
10398 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
10399 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconMask
, icon_mask
);
10400 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
10403 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10405 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= (IconPixmapHint
| IconMaskHint
);
10406 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
10408 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10412 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame
*f
, int icon_x
, int icon_y
)
10414 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
10416 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= IconPositionHint
;
10417 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_x
= icon_x
;
10418 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_y
= icon_y
;
10420 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
10424 /***********************************************************************
10426 ***********************************************************************/
10430 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
10434 x_check_font (struct frame
*f
, struct font
*font
)
10436 eassert (font
!= NULL
&& ! NILP (font
->props
[FONT_TYPE_INDEX
]));
10437 if (font
->driver
->check
)
10438 eassert (font
->driver
->check (f
, font
) == 0);
10441 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
10444 /***********************************************************************
10446 ***********************************************************************/
10448 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10449 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options
[] = {
10450 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10451 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg
, (XtPointer
) "yes"},
10453 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10454 XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10455 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10457 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10458 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10459 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10460 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10461 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10462 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10463 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
}
10466 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10468 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
;
10470 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10472 static int x_initialized
;
10474 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10475 the screen number from the server number. */
10477 same_x_server (const char *name1
, const char *name2
)
10479 int seen_colon
= 0;
10480 const char *system_name
= SSDATA (Vsystem_name
);
10481 ptrdiff_t system_name_length
= SBYTES (Vsystem_name
);
10482 ptrdiff_t length_until_period
= 0;
10484 while (system_name
[length_until_period
] != 0
10485 && system_name
[length_until_period
] != '.')
10486 length_until_period
++;
10488 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10489 if (! strncmp (name1
, "unix:", 5))
10491 if (! strncmp (name2
, "unix:", 5))
10493 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10494 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
10495 && name1
[system_name_length
] == ':')
10496 name1
+= system_name_length
;
10497 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
10498 && name2
[system_name_length
] == ':')
10499 name2
+= system_name_length
;
10500 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10501 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
10502 && name1
[length_until_period
] == ':')
10503 name1
+= length_until_period
;
10504 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
10505 && name2
[length_until_period
] == ':')
10506 name2
+= length_until_period
;
10508 for (; *name1
!= '\0' && *name1
== *name2
; name1
++, name2
++)
10512 if (seen_colon
&& *name1
== '.')
10516 && (*name1
== '.' || *name1
== '\0')
10517 && (*name2
== '.' || *name2
== '\0'));
10520 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10521 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10524 get_bits_and_offset (unsigned long mask
, int *bits
, int *offset
)
10529 while (!(mask
& 1))
10545 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
10546 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
10549 x_display_ok (const char *display
)
10551 Display
*dpy
= XOpenDisplay (display
);
10552 return dpy
? (XCloseDisplay (dpy
), 1) : 0;
10557 my_log_handler (const gchar
*log_domain
, GLogLevelFlags log_level
,
10558 const gchar
*msg
, gpointer user_data
)
10560 if (!strstr (msg
, "g_set_prgname"))
10561 fprintf (stderr
, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain
, msg
);
10565 /* Create invisible cursor on X display referred by DPYINFO. */
10568 make_invisible_cursor (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10570 Display
*dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
10571 static char const no_data
[] = { 0 };
10576 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
10577 pix
= XCreateBitmapFromData (dpy
, dpyinfo
->root_window
, no_data
, 1, 1);
10578 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy
) && pix
!= None
)
10582 col
.red
= col
.green
= col
.blue
= 0;
10583 col
.flags
= DoRed
| DoGreen
| DoBlue
;
10584 pixc
= XCreatePixmapCursor (dpy
, pix
, pix
, &col
, &col
, 0, 0);
10585 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy
) && pixc
!= None
)
10587 XFreePixmap (dpy
, pix
);
10590 x_uncatch_errors ();
10595 /* True if DPY supports Xfixes extension >= 4. */
10598 x_probe_xfixes_extension (Display
*dpy
)
10602 return XFixesQueryVersion (dpy
, &major
, &minor
) && major
>= 4;
10605 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
10608 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using Xfixes functions. */
10611 xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame
*f
, bool invisible
)
10615 XFixesHideCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10617 XFixesShowCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10618 f
->pointer_invisible
= invisible
;
10621 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
10624 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using invisible cursor. */
10627 x_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame
*f
, bool invisible
)
10629 eassert (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
!= 0);
10631 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
10632 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
);
10634 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
10635 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
);
10636 f
->pointer_invisible
= invisible
;
10639 /* Setup pointer blanking, prefer Xfixes if available. */
10642 x_setup_pointer_blanking (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10644 /* FIXME: the brave tester should set EMACS_XFIXES because we're suspecting
10645 X server bug, see http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=17609. */
10646 if (egetenv ("EMACS_XFIXES") && x_probe_xfixes_extension (dpyinfo
->display
))
10647 dpyinfo
->toggle_visible_pointer
= xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer
;
10650 dpyinfo
->toggle_visible_pointer
= x_toggle_visible_pointer
;
10651 dpyinfo
->invisible_cursor
= make_invisible_cursor (dpyinfo
);
10655 /* Current X display connection identifier. Incremented for each next
10656 connection established. */
10657 static unsigned x_display_id
;
10659 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
10660 the structure that describes the open display.
10661 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
10663 struct x_display_info
*
10664 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name
, char *xrm_option
, char *resource_name
)
10667 struct terminal
*terminal
;
10668 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
10674 if (!x_initialized
)
10680 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name
)))
10681 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name
));
10685 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10687 char *argv
[NUM_ARGV
];
10688 char **argv2
= argv
;
10691 if (x_initialized
++ > 1)
10693 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name
), &dpy
);
10697 static char display_opt
[] = "--display";
10698 static char name_opt
[] = "--name";
10700 for (argc
= 0; argc
< NUM_ARGV
; ++argc
)
10704 argv
[argc
++] = initial_argv
[0];
10706 if (! NILP (display_name
))
10708 argv
[argc
++] = display_opt
;
10709 argv
[argc
++] = SSDATA (display_name
);
10712 argv
[argc
++] = name_opt
;
10713 argv
[argc
++] = resource_name
;
10715 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10717 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10718 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10719 id
= g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING
| G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10720 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION
, my_log_handler
, NULL
);
10722 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10723 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10724 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL
, event_handler_gdk
, NULL
);
10726 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
10728 gtk_init (&argc
, &argv2
);
10731 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id
);
10735 dpy
= DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10737 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
10738 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10740 const char *file
= "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10741 Lisp_Object s
, abs_file
;
10743 s
= build_string (file
);
10744 abs_file
= Fexpand_file_name (s
, Qnil
);
10746 if (! NILP (abs_file
) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file
)))
10747 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file
));
10751 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
10752 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
10755 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10756 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10757 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10759 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10760 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10761 So let's not use it until R6. */
10762 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10763 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL
, NULL
, NULL
);
10774 argv
[argc
++] = "-xrm";
10775 argv
[argc
++] = xrm_option
;
10777 turn_on_atimers (0);
10778 dpy
= XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con
, SSDATA (display_name
),
10779 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
,
10780 emacs_options
, XtNumber (emacs_options
),
10782 turn_on_atimers (1);
10784 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10785 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10790 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10791 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10792 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name
));
10793 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10794 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10796 /* Detect failure. */
10803 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10805 dpyinfo
= xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo
);
10806 terminal
= x_create_terminal (dpyinfo
);
10809 struct x_display_info
*share
;
10811 for (share
= x_display_list
; share
; share
= share
->next
)
10812 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (share
->name_list_element
)),
10813 SSDATA (display_name
)))
10816 terminal
->kboard
= share
->terminal
->kboard
;
10819 terminal
->kboard
= allocate_kboard (Qx
);
10821 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
)->function
, Qunbound
))
10823 char *vendor
= ServerVendor (dpy
);
10825 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10826 list of terminals. */
10827 struct gcpro gcpro1
;
10828 Lisp_Object gcpro_term
;
10829 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term
, terminal
);
10830 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term
);
10832 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10833 terminal_list
= terminal
->next_terminal
;
10835 kset_system_key_alist
10837 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
,
10838 vendor
? build_string (vendor
) : empty_unibyte_string
));
10840 terminal
->next_terminal
= terminal_list
;
10841 terminal_list
= terminal
;
10845 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10846 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10847 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10848 if (current_kboard
== initial_kboard
)
10849 current_kboard
= terminal
->kboard
;
10851 terminal
->kboard
->reference_count
++;
10854 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10855 dpyinfo
->next
= x_display_list
;
10856 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
;
10858 dpyinfo
->name_list_element
= Fcons (display_name
, Qnil
);
10859 dpyinfo
->display
= dpy
;
10860 dpyinfo
->connection
= ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo
->display
);
10862 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10863 terminal
->name
= xlispstrdup (display_name
);
10866 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display
, x_trace_wire
);
10869 lim
= min (PTRDIFF_MAX
, SIZE_MAX
) - sizeof "@";
10870 if (lim
- SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name
))
10871 memory_full (SIZE_MAX
);
10872 dpyinfo
->x_id
= ++x_display_id
;
10873 dpyinfo
->x_id_name
= xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
)
10874 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name
) + 2);
10875 char *nametail
= lispstpcpy (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
, Vinvocation_name
);
10877 lispstpcpy (nametail
, Vsystem_name
);
10879 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10880 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
10882 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10884 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10885 dpyinfo
->xg_cursor
= xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo
->display
);
10886 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10888 dpyinfo
->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10889 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo
->display
, XC_sb_v_double_arrow
);
10891 dpyinfo
->horizontal_scroll_bar_cursor
10892 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo
->display
, XC_sb_h_double_arrow
);
10894 xrdb
= x_load_resources (dpyinfo
->display
, xrm_option
,
10895 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
);
10896 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10897 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, xrdb
);
10899 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= xrdb
;
10901 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10903 dpyinfo
->xrdb
= xrdb
;
10905 dpyinfo
->screen
= ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
,
10906 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo
->display
));
10907 select_visual (dpyinfo
);
10908 dpyinfo
->cmap
= DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10909 dpyinfo
->root_window
= RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10910 dpyinfo
->icon_bitmap_id
= -1;
10911 dpyinfo
->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
10913 reset_mouse_highlight (&dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
);
10915 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10916 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == TrueColor
)
10918 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->red_mask
,
10919 &dpyinfo
->red_bits
, &dpyinfo
->red_offset
);
10920 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->blue_mask
,
10921 &dpyinfo
->blue_bits
, &dpyinfo
->blue_offset
);
10922 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->green_mask
,
10923 &dpyinfo
->green_bits
, &dpyinfo
->green_offset
);
10926 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10927 if (dpyinfo
->visual
== DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
))
10929 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == PseudoColor
)
10931 AUTO_STRING (privateColormap
, "privateColormap");
10932 AUTO_STRING (PrivateColormap
, "PrivateColormap");
10934 = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
, privateColormap
,
10935 PrivateColormap
, Qnil
, Qnil
);
10936 if (STRINGP (value
)
10937 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
10938 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
10939 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->cmap
);
10943 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCreateColormap (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10944 dpyinfo
->visual
, AllocNone
);
10948 /* If we are using Xft, the following precautions should be made:
10950 1. Make sure that the Xrender extension is added before the Xft one.
10951 Otherwise, the close-display hook set by Xft is called after the one
10952 for Xrender, and the former tries to re-add the latter. This results
10953 in inconsistency of internal states and leads to X protocol error when
10954 one reconnects to the same X server (Bug#1696).
10956 2. Check dpi value in X resources. It is better we use it as well,
10957 since Xft will use it, as will all Gnome applications. If our real DPI
10958 is smaller or larger than the one Xft uses, our font will look smaller
10959 or larger than other for other applications, even if it is the same
10960 font name (monospace-10 for example). */
10962 int event_base
, error_base
;
10966 XRenderQueryExtension (dpyinfo
->display
, &event_base
, &error_base
);
10968 v
= XGetDefault (dpyinfo
->display
, "Xft", "dpi");
10969 if (v
!= NULL
&& sscanf (v
, "%lf", &d
) == 1)
10970 dpyinfo
->resy
= dpyinfo
->resx
= d
;
10974 if (dpyinfo
->resy
< 1)
10976 int screen_number
= XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10977 double pixels
= DisplayHeight (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10978 double mm
= DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10979 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10980 dpyinfo
->resy
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10981 pixels
= DisplayWidth (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10982 mm
= DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10983 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10984 dpyinfo
->resx
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10988 static const struct
10993 #define ATOM_REFS_INIT(string, member) \
10994 { string, offsetof (struct x_display_info, member) },
10995 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_PROTOCOLS", Xatom_wm_protocols
)
10996 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_TAKE_FOCUS", Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
10997 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
10998 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_DELETE_WINDOW", Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
10999 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CHANGE_STATE", Xatom_wm_change_state
)
11000 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
11001 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_MOVED", Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
11002 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CLIENT_LEADER", Xatom_wm_client_leader
)
11003 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("Editres", Xatom_editres
)
11004 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD", Xatom_CLIPBOARD
)
11005 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TIMESTAMP", Xatom_TIMESTAMP
)
11006 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TEXT", Xatom_TEXT
)
11007 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("COMPOUND_TEXT", Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
)
11008 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("UTF8_STRING", Xatom_UTF8_STRING
)
11009 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DELETE", Xatom_DELETE
)
11010 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MULTIPLE", Xatom_MULTIPLE
)
11011 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("INCR", Xatom_INCR
)
11012 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_EMACS_TMP_", Xatom_EMACS_TMP
)
11013 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TARGETS", Xatom_TARGETS
)
11014 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("NULL", Xatom_NULL
)
11015 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM", Xatom_ATOM
)
11016 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM_PAIR", Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
)
11017 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER
)
11018 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED_INFO", Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
)
11019 /* For properties of font. */
11020 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PIXEL_SIZE", Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
)
11021 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("AVERAGE_WIDTH", Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
)
11022 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
)
11023 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
)
11024 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
)
11025 /* Ghostscript support. */
11026 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DONE", Xatom_DONE
)
11027 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PAGE", Xatom_PAGE
)
11028 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Scrollbar
)
11029 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("HORIZONTAL_SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
)
11030 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED", Xatom_XEMBED
)
11032 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE", Xatom_net_wm_state
)
11033 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
)
11034 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
11035 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
)
11036 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
11037 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
)
11038 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
)
11039 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden
)
11040 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", Xatom_net_window_type
)
11041 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
11042 Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip
)
11043 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_icon_name
)
11044 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_name
)
11045 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTED", Xatom_net_supported
)
11046 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
)
11047 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
)
11048 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", Xatom_net_active_window
)
11049 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", Xatom_net_frame_extents
)
11050 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", Xatom_net_current_desktop
)
11051 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WORKAREA", Xatom_net_workarea
)
11052 /* Session management */
11053 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SM_CLIENT_ID", Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID
)
11054 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", Xatom_xsettings_prop
)
11055 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MANAGER", Xatom_xsettings_mgr
)
11059 enum { atom_count
= ARRAYELTS (atom_refs
) };
11060 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN. */
11061 enum { total_atom_count
= 1 + atom_count
};
11062 Atom atoms_return
[total_atom_count
];
11063 char *atom_names
[total_atom_count
];
11064 static char const xsettings_fmt
[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
11065 char xsettings_atom_name
[sizeof xsettings_fmt
- 2
11066 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
11068 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
11069 atom_names
[i
] = (char *) atom_refs
[i
].name
;
11071 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name. */
11072 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name
, xsettings_fmt
,
11073 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
));
11074 atom_names
[i
] = xsettings_atom_name
;
11076 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo
->display
, atom_names
, total_atom_count
,
11077 False
, atoms_return
);
11079 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
11080 *(Atom
*) ((char *) dpyinfo
+ atom_refs
[i
].offset
) = atoms_return
[i
];
11082 /* Manually copy last atom. */
11083 dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_sel
= atoms_return
[i
];
11086 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
= 8;
11087 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
= xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
11088 * dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
);
11090 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
11091 gray_bits
, gray_width
, gray_height
,
11094 x_setup_pointer_blanking (dpyinfo
);
11097 xim_initialize (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
11100 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo
);
11102 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
11103 if (dpyinfo
->connection
!= 0)
11104 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo
->connection
);
11107 fcntl (dpyinfo
->connection
, F_SETOWN
, getpid ());
11108 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
11110 if (interrupt_input
)
11111 init_sigio (dpyinfo
->connection
);
11115 XrmValue d
, fr
, to
;
11118 dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
11119 d
.addr
= (XPointer
)&dpy
;
11120 d
.size
= sizeof (Display
*);
11121 fr
.addr
= XtDefaultFont
;
11122 fr
.size
= sizeof (XtDefaultFont
);
11123 to
.size
= sizeof (Font
*);
11124 to
.addr
= (XPointer
)&font
;
11125 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
11126 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy
, XtCvtStringToFont
, &d
, 1, &fr
, &to
, NULL
))
11128 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
) || !XQueryFont (dpy
, font
))
11129 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb
, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
11130 /* Do not free XFontStruct returned by the above call to XQueryFont.
11131 This leads to X protocol errors at XtCloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
11132 x_uncatch_errors ();
11136 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
11137 for debugging X code. */
11139 AUTO_STRING (synchronous
, "synchronous");
11140 AUTO_STRING (Synchronous
, "Synchronous");
11141 Lisp_Object value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
, synchronous
,
11142 Synchronous
, Qnil
, Qnil
);
11143 if (STRINGP (value
)
11144 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
11145 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
11146 XSynchronize (dpyinfo
->display
, True
);
11150 AUTO_STRING (useXIM
, "useXIM");
11151 AUTO_STRING (UseXIM
, "UseXIM");
11152 Lisp_Object value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
, useXIM
, UseXIM
,
11155 if (STRINGP (value
)
11156 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "false")
11157 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "off")))
11160 if (STRINGP (value
)
11161 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
11162 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
11168 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
11169 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
11170 tty or started as a daemon. */
11171 if (terminal
->id
== 1 && ! IS_DAEMON
)
11172 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo
);
11180 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
11181 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
11184 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
11186 struct terminal
*t
;
11188 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
11190 for (t
= terminal_list
; t
; t
= t
->next_terminal
)
11191 if (t
->type
== output_x_window
&& t
->display_info
.x
== dpyinfo
)
11194 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
11195 if (t
->id
== 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
11196 x_session_close ();
11198 delete_terminal (t
);
11202 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== dpyinfo
)
11203 next_noop_dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
;
11205 if (x_display_list
== dpyinfo
)
11206 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
->next
;
11209 struct x_display_info
*tail
;
11211 for (tail
= x_display_list
; tail
; tail
= tail
->next
)
11212 if (tail
->next
== dpyinfo
)
11213 tail
->next
= tail
->next
->next
;
11216 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
);
11217 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
);
11218 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
11222 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11224 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11225 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11226 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11227 that slows us down. */
11230 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer
*timer
)
11233 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 0;
11234 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
|| popup_activated ())
11236 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con
) & XtIMTimer
)
11237 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con
, XtIMTimer
);
11238 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11239 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11244 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11245 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11246 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11247 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11248 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11249 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11250 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11253 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
11256 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
)
11258 struct timespec interval
= make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
11259 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE
, interval
, x_process_timeouts
, 0);
11260 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 1;
11265 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11268 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11270 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface
=
11272 x_frame_parm_handlers
,
11276 x_clear_end_of_line
,
11278 x_after_update_window_line
,
11279 x_update_window_begin
,
11280 x_update_window_end
,
11282 x_clear_window_mouse_face
,
11283 x_get_glyph_overhangs
,
11284 x_fix_overlapping_area
,
11285 x_draw_fringe_bitmap
,
11286 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11287 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11288 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs
,
11289 x_draw_glyph_string
,
11290 x_define_frame_cursor
,
11291 x_clear_frame_area
,
11292 x_draw_window_cursor
,
11293 x_draw_vertical_window_border
,
11294 x_draw_window_divider
,
11295 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
,
11301 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
11303 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*terminal
)
11305 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= terminal
->display_info
.x
;
11307 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
11308 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
11309 if (!terminal
->name
)
11314 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
11317 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo
);
11320 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
11321 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
11322 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
11324 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo
);
11325 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo
->display
, DestroyAll
);
11327 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
11328 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
11329 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
11330 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
11332 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
11333 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
11334 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
11335 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
11336 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
11337 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
11338 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
11339 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
11340 leaks in other situations. */
11342 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
11343 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, NULL
);
11345 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= NULL
;
11347 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
11348 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
11349 closing all the displays. */
11350 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo
->xrdb
);
11354 xg_display_close (dpyinfo
->display
);
11356 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11357 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
11359 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
11361 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
11363 /* No more input on this descriptor. Do not close it because
11364 it's already closed by X(t)CloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
11365 eassert (0 <= dpyinfo
->connection
);
11366 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo
->connection
);
11368 /* Mark as dead. */
11369 dpyinfo
->display
= NULL
;
11370 dpyinfo
->connection
= -1;
11373 x_delete_display (dpyinfo
);
11377 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
11378 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
11380 static struct terminal
*
11381 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
11383 struct terminal
*terminal
;
11385 terminal
= create_terminal (output_x_window
, &x_redisplay_interface
);
11387 terminal
->display_info
.x
= dpyinfo
;
11388 dpyinfo
->terminal
= terminal
;
11390 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
11392 terminal
->clear_frame_hook
= x_clear_frame
;
11393 terminal
->ins_del_lines_hook
= x_ins_del_lines
;
11394 terminal
->delete_glyphs_hook
= x_delete_glyphs
;
11395 terminal
->ring_bell_hook
= XTring_bell
;
11396 terminal
->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook
= XTtoggle_invisible_pointer
;
11397 terminal
->update_begin_hook
= x_update_begin
;
11398 terminal
->update_end_hook
= x_update_end
;
11399 terminal
->read_socket_hook
= XTread_socket
;
11400 terminal
->frame_up_to_date_hook
= XTframe_up_to_date
;
11401 terminal
->mouse_position_hook
= XTmouse_position
;
11402 terminal
->frame_rehighlight_hook
= XTframe_rehighlight
;
11403 terminal
->frame_raise_lower_hook
= XTframe_raise_lower
;
11404 terminal
->fullscreen_hook
= XTfullscreen_hook
;
11405 terminal
->menu_show_hook
= x_menu_show
;
11406 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
11407 terminal
->popup_dialog_hook
= xw_popup_dialog
;
11409 terminal
->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook
= XTset_vertical_scroll_bar
;
11410 terminal
->set_horizontal_scroll_bar_hook
= XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar
;
11411 terminal
->condemn_scroll_bars_hook
= XTcondemn_scroll_bars
;
11412 terminal
->redeem_scroll_bar_hook
= XTredeem_scroll_bar
;
11413 terminal
->judge_scroll_bars_hook
= XTjudge_scroll_bars
;
11414 terminal
->delete_frame_hook
= x_destroy_window
;
11415 terminal
->delete_terminal_hook
= x_delete_terminal
;
11416 /* Other hooks are NULL by default. */
11422 x_initialize (void)
11427 any_help_event_p
= 0;
11428 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
11431 current_count
= -1;
11434 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11435 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt
);
11437 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11438 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11440 Xt_app_con
= XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11442 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11443 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11444 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con
,
11445 XtRString
, XtRPixel
, cvt_string_to_pixel
,
11446 cvt_string_to_pixel_args
,
11447 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args
),
11448 XtCacheByDisplay
, cvt_pixel_dtor
);
11450 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con
, Xt_default_resources
);
11453 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11455 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= False
;
11456 xaw3d_pick_top
= True
;
11460 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11461 original error handler. */
11462 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
11463 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
11470 /* Emacs can handle only core input events, so make sure
11471 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
11472 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
11477 syms_of_xterm (void)
11479 x_error_message
= NULL
;
11481 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
11482 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1
, "latin-1");
11485 xg_default_icon_file
= build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
11486 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file
);
11488 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock
, "x-gtk-map-stock");
11491 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11492 x_use_underline_position_properties
,
11493 doc
: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11494 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11495 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11496 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
11497 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
11499 x_use_underline_position_properties
= 1;
11501 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11502 x_underline_at_descent_line
,
11503 doc
: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11504 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
11505 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
11506 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
11507 x_underline_at_descent_line
= 0;
11509 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11510 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
,
11511 doc
: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11512 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11513 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11514 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11515 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11516 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11517 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
= 0;
11519 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
,
11520 doc
: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
11521 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
11522 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
11523 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
11524 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
11525 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11527 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("motif");
11528 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11529 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
11531 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("gtk");
11533 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw");
11536 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= Qnil
;
11539 DEFSYM (Qmodifier_value
, "modifier-value");
11540 DEFSYM (Qalt
, "alt");
11541 Fput (Qalt
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (alt_modifier
));
11542 DEFSYM (Qhyper
, "hyper");
11543 Fput (Qhyper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (hyper_modifier
));
11544 DEFSYM (Qmeta
, "meta");
11545 Fput (Qmeta
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (meta_modifier
));
11546 DEFSYM (Qsuper
, "super");
11547 Fput (Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (super_modifier
));
11549 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym
,
11550 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11551 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11552 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11553 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11554 Vx_alt_keysym
= Qnil
;
11556 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym
,
11557 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11558 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11559 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11560 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11561 Vx_hyper_keysym
= Qnil
;
11563 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym
,
11564 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11565 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11566 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11567 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11568 Vx_meta_keysym
= Qnil
;
11570 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym
,
11571 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11572 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11573 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11574 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11575 Vx_super_keysym
= Qnil
;
11577 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table
,
11578 doc
: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11579 Vx_keysym_table
= make_hash_table (hashtest_eql
, make_number (900),
11580 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE
),
11581 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD
),